Merge from emacs-23; up to 2010-06-10T12:56:11Z!michael.albinus@gmx.de.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #include <unistd.h>
93
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
97
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
138
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
145
146 \f
147
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
150
151 static int any_help_event_p;
152
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
155
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
158
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
160
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
165
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
167
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
172
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
174
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
176
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
178
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
180
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
185
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190
191 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
192
193 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
194 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
195
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
199
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
201
202 /* Mouse movement.
203
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
208
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
210
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
221
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
223
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
227
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
229
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
233
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
237
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
239
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
246
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
248
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
250
251 static Time last_user_time;
252
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
255
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
263
264 static int x_noop_count;
265
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
267
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
270
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
274
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
278
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
281
282 enum xembed_info
283 {
284 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
285 };
286
287 enum xembed_message
288 {
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
297
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
303 };
304
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
306
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
309 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
310 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
311 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
312 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
313
314 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
315 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
316 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
317 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
318 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
319 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
320 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
322 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
323 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
324 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
325 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
326 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
327 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
328 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
329 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
330 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
331 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
332 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
333 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
334 enum text_cursor_kinds);
335
336 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
337 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
338 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
339 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
340 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
341 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
342 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
343 enum scroll_bar_part *,
344 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
345 unsigned long *);
346 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
347 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
348 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
349 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
350 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
351 int *, struct input_event *);
352 #ifdef USE_GTK
353 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
354 #endif
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
358 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
359 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, int);
360 static void x_initialize (void);
361
362
363 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
364
365 static void
366 x_flush (struct frame *f)
367 {
368 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
369 connection may be broken. */
370 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
371 return;
372
373 BLOCK_INPUT;
374 if (f == NULL)
375 {
376 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
377 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
378 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
380 }
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 }
385
386
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
393
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
395
396 \f
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
400
401 #if 0
402
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
405
406 struct record
407 {
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
410 };
411
412 struct record event_record[100];
413
414 int event_record_index;
415
416 void
417 record_event (char *locus, int type)
418 {
419 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
420 event_record_index = 0;
421
422 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
423 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
424 event_record_index++;
425 }
426
427 #endif /* 0 */
428
429
430 \f
431 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
432
433 struct x_display_info *
434 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
435 {
436 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
437
438 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
439 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
440 return dpyinfo;
441
442 return 0;
443 }
444
445 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
446
447 void
448 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
449 {
450 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
451 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
452 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
453 double alpha = 1.0;
454 double alpha_min = 1.0;
455 unsigned long opac;
456
457 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
458 alpha = f->alpha[0];
459 else
460 alpha = f->alpha[1];
461
462 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
463 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
464 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
465 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
466
467 if (alpha < 0.0)
468 return;
469 else if (alpha > 1.0)
470 alpha = 1.0;
471 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
472 alpha = alpha_min;
473
474 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
475
476 /* return unless necessary */
477 {
478 unsigned char *data;
479 Atom actual;
480 int rc, format;
481 unsigned long n, left;
482
483 x_catch_errors (dpy);
484 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
485 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
486 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
487 &data);
488
489 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
490 {
491 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
492 XFree ((void *) data);
493 if (value == opac)
494 {
495 x_uncatch_errors ();
496 return;
497 }
498 }
499 }
500
501 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
503 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
504 x_uncatch_errors ();
505 }
506
507 int
508 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
509 {
510 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
511 }
512
513 int
514 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
515 {
516 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
517 }
518
519 \f
520 /***********************************************************************
521 Starting and ending an update
522 ***********************************************************************/
523
524 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
525 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
526 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
527 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
528 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
529
530 static void
531 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
532 {
533 /* Nothing to do. */
534 }
535
536
537 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
538 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
539 position of W. */
540
541 static void
542 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
543 {
544 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
545 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
546
547 updated_window = w;
548 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
549
550 BLOCK_INPUT;
551
552 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
553 {
554 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
555 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
556
557 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
558 highlighting. */
559 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
560 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
561 }
562
563 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
564 }
565
566
567 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
568
569 static void
570 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
571 {
572 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
573 struct face *face;
574
575 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
576 if (face)
577 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
578 face->foreground);
579
580 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
581 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
582 }
583
584 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
585
586 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
587 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
588
589 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
590 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
591 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
592
593 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
594 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
595 here. */
596
597 static void
598 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
599 {
600 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
601
602 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
603 {
604 BLOCK_INPUT;
605
606 if (cursor_on_p)
607 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
608 output_cursor.vpos,
609 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
610
611 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
612 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
613
614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
615 }
616
617 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
618 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
619 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
620 {
621 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
622 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
623 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
624 }
625
626 updated_window = NULL;
627 }
628
629
630 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
631 update_end. */
632
633 static void
634 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
635 {
636 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
637 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
638
639 #ifndef XFlush
640 BLOCK_INPUT;
641 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
642 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
643 #endif
644 }
645
646
647 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
648 complete update has been performed. The global variable
649 updated_window is not available here. */
650
651 static void
652 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
653 {
654 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
655 {
656 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
657
658 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
659 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
660 {
661 BLOCK_INPUT;
662 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
663 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
664 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
665 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
666 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
667 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
668 }
669 }
670 }
671
672
673 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
674 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
675 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
676 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
677 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
678 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
679
680 static void
681 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
682 {
683 struct window *w = updated_window;
684 struct frame *f;
685 int width, height;
686
687 xassert (w);
688
689 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
690 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
691
692 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
693 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
694 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
695 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
696 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
697 overhead is very small. */
698 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
699 && desired_row->full_width_p
700 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
701 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
702 width != 0)
703 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
704 height > 0))
705 {
706 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
707
708 BLOCK_INPUT;
709 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
710 0, y, width, height, False);
711 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
712 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
713 y, width, height, False);
714 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
715 }
716 }
717
718 static void
719 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
720 {
721 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
722 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
723 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
724 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
725 struct face *face = p->face;
726
727 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
728 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
729
730 if (!p->overlay_p)
731 {
732 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
733
734 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
735 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
736 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
737 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
738 if (face->stipple)
739 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
740 else
741 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
742
743 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
744 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
745 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
746 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
747 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
748 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
749 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
750 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
751 {
752 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
753
754 if (sb_width > 0)
755 {
756 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
757 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
758 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
759
760 if (bx < 0)
761 {
762 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
763 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
764 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
765 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
766 bx = bar_area_x;
767 if (bx >= 0)
768 {
769 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
770
771 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
772 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
773 row->y));
774 ny = row->visible_height;
775 }
776 }
777 else
778 {
779 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
780 {
781 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
782 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
783 }
784 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
785 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
786 }
787 }
788 }
789 #endif
790 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
791 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
792
793 if (!face->stipple)
794 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
795 }
796
797 if (p->which)
798 {
799 char *bits;
800 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
801 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
802 XGCValues gcv;
803
804 if (p->wd > 8)
805 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
806 else
807 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
808
809 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
810 by the server. */
811 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
812 (p->cursor_p
813 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
814 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
815 : face->foreground),
816 face->background, depth);
817
818 if (p->overlay_p)
819 {
820 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
821 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
822 bits, p->wd, p->h,
823 1, 0, 1);
824 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
825 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
826 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
827 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
828 }
829
830 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
831 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
832 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
833
834 if (p->overlay_p)
835 {
836 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
837 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
838 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
839 }
840 }
841
842 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
843 }
844
845 \f
846
847 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
848 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
849 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
850 rarely happens). */
851
852 static void
853 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
854 {
855 }
856
857 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
858 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
859
860 static void
861 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
862 {
863 }
864
865 \f
866 /***********************************************************************
867 Glyph display
868 ***********************************************************************/
869
870
871
872 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
873 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
874 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
875 int);
876 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
881 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
885 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
886 unsigned long *, double, int);
887 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
888 double, int, unsigned long);
889 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
891 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
892 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
894 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
895 int, int, int);
896 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
897 int, int, int, int, int, int,
898 XRectangle *);
899 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
901 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
902
903 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
904 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
905 #endif
906
907
908 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
909 face. */
910
911 static void
912 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
913 {
914 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
915 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
916 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
917 && !s->cmp)
918 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
919 else
920 {
921 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
922 XGCValues xgcv;
923 unsigned long mask;
924
925 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
926 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
927
928 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
929 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
930 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
931 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
932 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
933 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
934 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
935
936 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
937 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
938 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
939 {
940 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
941 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
942 }
943
944 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
945 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
946 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
947
948 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
949 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
950 mask, &xgcv);
951 else
952 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
953 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
954
955 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
956 }
957 }
958
959
960 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
961
962 static void
963 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
964 {
965 int face_id;
966 struct face *face;
967
968 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
969 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
970 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
971 if (face == NULL)
972 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
973
974 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
975 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
976 else
977 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
978 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
979 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
980
981 if (s->font == s->face->font)
982 s->gc = s->face->gc;
983 else
984 {
985 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
986 except for FONT. */
987 XGCValues xgcv;
988 unsigned long mask;
989
990 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
991 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
992 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
993 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
994
995 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
996 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
997 mask, &xgcv);
998 else
999 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1000 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1001
1002 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1003
1004 }
1005 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1006 }
1007
1008
1009 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1010 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1011 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1012
1013 static INLINE void
1014 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1015 {
1016 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1017 }
1018
1019
1020 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1021 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1022 pattern. */
1023
1024 static INLINE void
1025 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1026 {
1027 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1028
1029 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1030 {
1031 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1032 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1033 }
1034 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1035 {
1036 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1037 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1038 }
1039 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1040 {
1041 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1042 s->stippled_p = 0;
1043 }
1044 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1045 {
1046 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1047 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1048 }
1049 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1050 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1051 {
1052 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1053 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1054 }
1055 else
1056 {
1057 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1058 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1059 }
1060
1061 /* GC must have been set. */
1062 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1063 }
1064
1065
1066 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1067 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1068
1069 static INLINE void
1070 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1071 {
1072 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1073 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1074
1075 if (n > 0)
1076 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1077 s->num_clips = n;
1078 }
1079
1080
1081 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1082 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1083 the area of SRC. */
1084
1085 static void
1086 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1087 {
1088 XRectangle r;
1089
1090 r.x = src->x;
1091 r.width = src->width;
1092 r.y = src->y;
1093 r.height = src->height;
1094 dst->clip[0] = r;
1095 dst->num_clips = 1;
1096 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* RIF:
1101 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1102
1103 static void
1104 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1105 {
1106 if (s->cmp == NULL
1107 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1108 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1109 {
1110 struct font_metrics metrics;
1111
1112 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1113 {
1114 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1115 struct font *font = s->font;
1116 int i;
1117
1118 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1119 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1120 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1121 }
1122 else
1123 {
1124 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1125
1126 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1127 }
1128 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1129 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1130 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->cmp)
1133 {
1134 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1135 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1136 }
1137 }
1138
1139
1140 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1141
1142 static INLINE void
1143 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1144 {
1145 XGCValues xgcv;
1146 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1147 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1148 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1149 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1150 }
1151
1152
1153 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1154 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1155 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1156 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1157 contains the first component of a composition. */
1158
1159 static void
1160 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1161 {
1162 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1163 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1164 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1165 {
1166 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1167
1168 if (s->stippled_p)
1169 {
1170 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1171 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1172 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1173 s->y + box_line_width,
1174 s->background_width,
1175 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1176 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1177 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1178 }
1179 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1180 || s->font_not_found_p
1181 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1182 || force_p)
1183 {
1184 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1185 s->background_width,
1186 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1187 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1188 }
1189 }
1190 }
1191
1192
1193 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1194
1195 static void
1196 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1197 {
1198 int i, x;
1199
1200 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1201 of S to the right of that box line. */
1202 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1203 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1204 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1205 else
1206 x = s->x;
1207
1208 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1209 loaded. */
1210 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1211 {
1212 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1213 {
1214 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1215 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1216 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1217 s->height - 1);
1218 x += g->pixel_width;
1219 }
1220 }
1221 else
1222 {
1223 struct font *font = s->font;
1224 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1225 int y;
1226
1227 if (font->vertical_centering)
1228 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1229
1230 y = s->ybase - boff;
1231 if (s->for_overlaps
1232 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1233 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1234 else
1235 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1236 if (s->face->overstrike)
1237 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1238 }
1239 }
1240
1241 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1242
1243 static void
1244 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1245 {
1246 int i, j, x;
1247 struct font *font = s->font;
1248
1249 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1250 of S to the right of that box line. */
1251 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1252 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1253 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1254 else
1255 x = s->x;
1256
1257 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1258 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1259 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1260 this composition. */
1261
1262 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1263 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1264 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1265 {
1266 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1267 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1268 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1269 }
1270 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1271 {
1272 int y = s->ybase;
1273
1274 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1275 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1276 {
1277 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1278 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1279
1280 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1281 if (s->face->overstrike)
1282 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1283 }
1284 }
1285 else
1286 {
1287 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1288 Lisp_Object glyph;
1289 int y = s->ybase;
1290 int width = 0;
1291
1292 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1293 {
1294 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1295 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1296 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1297 else
1298 {
1299 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1300
1301 if (j < i)
1302 {
1303 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1304 if (s->face->overstrike)
1305 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1306 x += width;
1307 }
1308 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1309 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1310 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1311 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1312 if (s->face->overstrike)
1313 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1314 x += wadjust;
1315 j = i + 1;
1316 width = 0;
1317 }
1318 }
1319 if (j < i)
1320 {
1321 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1322 if (s->face->overstrike)
1323 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1324 }
1325 }
1326 }
1327
1328
1329 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1330
1331 static void
1332 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1333 {
1334 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1335 XChar2b char2b[8];
1336 int x, i, j;
1337
1338 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1339 of S to the right of that box line. */
1340 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1341 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1342 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1343 else
1344 x = s->x;
1345
1346 s->char2b = char2b;
1347
1348 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1349 {
1350 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1351 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1352
1353 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1354 {
1355 if (len > 0
1356 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1357 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1358 >= 1))
1359 {
1360 Lisp_Object acronym
1361 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1362 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1363 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1364 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1365 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1366 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1367 }
1368 }
1369 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1370 {
1371 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1372 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1373 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1374 str = buf;
1375 }
1376
1377 if (str)
1378 {
1379 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1380 unsigned code;
1381
1382 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1383 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1384 {
1385 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1386 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1387 }
1388 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1389 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1390 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1391 0);
1392 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1393 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1394 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1395 0);
1396 }
1397 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1398 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1399 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1400 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1401 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1402 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1403 }
1404 }
1405
1406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1407
1408 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1409 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1410 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1411 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1412 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1413
1414
1415 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1416 cannot be determined. */
1417
1418 static struct frame *
1419 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1420 {
1421 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1422 Lisp_Object tail;
1423 struct frame *f;
1424
1425 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1426
1427 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1428 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1429 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1430 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1431 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1432 widget = XtParent (widget);
1433
1434 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1435 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1436 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1437 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1438 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1439 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1440 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1441 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1442 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1443 return f;
1444
1445 abort ();
1446 }
1447
1448
1449 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1450 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1451 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1452 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1453 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1454 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1455
1456 int
1457 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1458 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1459 {
1460 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1461 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1462 }
1463
1464
1465 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1466 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1467
1468 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1469 {
1470 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1471 sizeof (Screen *)},
1472 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1473 sizeof (Colormap)}
1474 };
1475
1476
1477 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1479
1480 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1481
1482
1483 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1484
1485 DPY is the display we are working on.
1486
1487 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1488 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1489 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1490 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1491
1492 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1493 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1494
1495 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1496 we allocated the color or not.
1497
1498 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1499
1500 static Boolean
1501 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1502 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1503 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1504 {
1505 Screen *screen;
1506 Colormap cmap;
1507 Pixel pixel;
1508 String color_name;
1509 XColor color;
1510
1511 if (*nargs != 2)
1512 {
1513 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1514 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1515 "XtToolkitError",
1516 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1517 return False;
1518 }
1519
1520 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1521 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1522 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1523
1524 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1525 {
1526 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1527 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1528 }
1529 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1530 {
1531 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1532 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1533 }
1534 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1535 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1536 {
1537 pixel = color.pixel;
1538 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1539 }
1540 else
1541 {
1542 String params[1];
1543 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1544
1545 params[0] = color_name;
1546 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1547 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1548 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1549 params, &nparams);
1550 return False;
1551 }
1552
1553 if (to->addr != NULL)
1554 {
1555 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1556 {
1557 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1558 return False;
1559 }
1560
1561 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1562 }
1563 else
1564 {
1565 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1566 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1567 }
1568
1569 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1570 return True;
1571 }
1572
1573
1574 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1575 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1576 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1577
1578 APP is the application context in which we work.
1579
1580 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1581 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1582 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1583
1584 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1585
1586 static void
1587 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1588 Cardinal *nargs)
1589 {
1590 if (*nargs != 2)
1591 {
1592 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1593 "XtToolkitError",
1594 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1595 NULL, NULL);
1596 }
1597 else if (closure != NULL)
1598 {
1599 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1600 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1601 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1602 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1603 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1604 }
1605 }
1606
1607
1608 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1609
1610
1611 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1612 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1613 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1614 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1615
1616 static const XColor *
1617 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1618 {
1619 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1620
1621 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1622 {
1623 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1624 int i;
1625
1626 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1627 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1628 dpyinfo->color_cells
1629 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1630 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1631
1632 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1633 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1634
1635 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1637 }
1638
1639 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1640 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1641 }
1642
1643
1644 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1645 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1646
1647 void
1648 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1649 {
1650 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1651
1652 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1653 {
1654 int i;
1655 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1656 {
1657 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1658 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1659 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1660 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1661 }
1662 }
1663 else
1664 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1665 }
1666
1667
1668 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1669 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1670
1671 void
1672 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1673 {
1674 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1675 }
1676
1677
1678 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1679 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1680 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1681 allocated. */
1682
1683 static int
1684 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1685 {
1686 int rc;
1687
1688 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1689 if (rc == 0)
1690 {
1691 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1692 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1693 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1694 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1695 int nearest, i;
1696 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~ (unsigned long) 0;
1697 int ncells;
1698 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1699
1700 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1701 {
1702 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1703 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1704 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1705 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1706
1707 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1708 {
1709 nearest = i;
1710 nearest_delta = delta;
1711 }
1712 }
1713
1714 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1715 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1716 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1717 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1718 }
1719 else
1720 {
1721 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1722 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1723 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1724 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1725 XColor *cached_color;
1726
1727 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1728 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1729 (cached_color->red != color->red
1730 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1731 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1732 {
1733 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1734 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1735 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1736 }
1737 }
1738
1739 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1740 if (rc)
1741 register_color (color->pixel);
1742 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1743
1744 return rc;
1745 }
1746
1747
1748 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1749 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1750 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1751 allocated. */
1752
1753 int
1754 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1755 {
1756 gamma_correct (f, color);
1757 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1758 }
1759
1760
1761 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1762 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1763 get color reference counts right. */
1764
1765 unsigned long
1766 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1767 {
1768 XColor color;
1769
1770 color.pixel = pixel;
1771 BLOCK_INPUT;
1772 x_query_color (f, &color);
1773 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1774 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1775 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1776 register_color (pixel);
1777 #endif
1778 return color.pixel;
1779 }
1780
1781
1782 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1783 boosted.
1784
1785 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1786 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1787 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1788 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1789 use an additional additive factor.
1790
1791 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1792 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1793 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1794
1795
1796 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1797 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1798 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1799 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1800 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1801 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1802
1803 static int
1804 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1805 {
1806 XColor color, new;
1807 long bright;
1808 int success_p;
1809
1810 /* Get RGB color values. */
1811 color.pixel = *pixel;
1812 x_query_color (f, &color);
1813
1814 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1815 xassert (factor >= 0);
1816 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1817 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1818 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1819
1820 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1821 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1822
1823 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1824 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1825 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1826 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1827 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1828 {
1829 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1830 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1831 /* The additive adjustment. */
1832 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1833
1834 if (factor < 1)
1835 {
1836 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1837 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1838 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1839 }
1840 else
1841 {
1842 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1843 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1844 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1845 }
1846 }
1847
1848 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1849 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1850 if (success_p)
1851 {
1852 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1853 {
1854 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1855 delta to the RGB values. */
1856 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1857
1858 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1859 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1860 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1861 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1862 }
1863 else
1864 success_p = 1;
1865 *pixel = new.pixel;
1866 }
1867
1868 return success_p;
1869 }
1870
1871
1872 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1873 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1874 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1875 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1876 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1877 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1878
1879 static void
1880 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1881 {
1882 XGCValues xgcv;
1883 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1884 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1885 unsigned long pixel;
1886 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1887 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1888 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1889 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1890
1891 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1892 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1893
1894 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1895 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1896 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1897 if (relief->gc
1898 && relief->allocated_p)
1899 {
1900 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1901 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1902 }
1903
1904 /* Allocate new color. */
1905 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1906 pixel = background;
1907 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1908 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1909 {
1910 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1911 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1912 }
1913
1914 if (relief->gc == 0)
1915 {
1916 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1917 mask |= GCStipple;
1918 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1919 }
1920 else
1921 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1922 }
1923
1924
1925 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1926
1927 static void
1928 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1929 {
1930 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1931 unsigned long color;
1932
1933 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1934 color = s->face->box_color;
1935 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1936 && s->img->pixmap
1937 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1938 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1939 else
1940 {
1941 XGCValues xgcv;
1942
1943 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1944 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1945 color = xgcv.background;
1946 }
1947
1948 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1949 || color != di->relief_background)
1950 {
1951 di->relief_background = color;
1952 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1953 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1954 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1955 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1956 }
1957 }
1958
1959
1960 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1961 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1962 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1963 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1964 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1965 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1966 when drawing. */
1967
1968 static void
1969 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1970 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1971 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1972 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1973 {
1974 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1975 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1976 int i;
1977 GC gc;
1978
1979 if (raised_p)
1980 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1981 else
1982 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1983 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1984
1985 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1986 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1987 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1988 corner pixels. */
1989
1990 /* Top. */
1991 if (top_p)
1992 {
1993 if (width == 1)
1994 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1995 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
1996 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
1997
1998 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
1999 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2000 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2001 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2002 }
2003
2004 /* Left. */
2005 if (left_p)
2006 {
2007 if (width == 1)
2008 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2009
2010 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2011 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2012
2013 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2014 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2015 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2016 }
2017
2018 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2019 if (raised_p)
2020 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2021 else
2022 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2023 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2024
2025 if (width > 1)
2026 {
2027 /* Outermost top line. */
2028 if (top_p)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2030 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2031 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2032
2033 /* Outermost left line. */
2034 if (left_p)
2035 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2036 }
2037
2038 /* Bottom. */
2039 if (bot_p)
2040 {
2041 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2042 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2043 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2044 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2045 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2046 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2047 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2048 }
2049
2050 /* Right. */
2051 if (right_p)
2052 {
2053 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2054 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2055 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2057 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2058 }
2059
2060 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2061 }
2062
2063
2064 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2065 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2066 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2067 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2068 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2069 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2070
2071 static void
2072 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2073 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2074 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2075 {
2076 XGCValues xgcv;
2077
2078 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2079 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2080 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2081
2082 /* Top. */
2083 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2084 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2085
2086 /* Left. */
2087 if (left_p)
2088 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2089 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2090
2091 /* Bottom. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2094
2095 /* Right. */
2096 if (right_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2099
2100 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2101 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2102 }
2103
2104
2105 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2106
2107 static void
2108 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2109 {
2110 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2111 int left_p, right_p;
2112 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2113 XRectangle clip_rect;
2114
2115 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2116 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2117 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2118
2119 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2120 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2121 ? s->first_glyph
2122 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2123
2124 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2125 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2126 left_x = s->x;
2127 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2128 ? last_x - 1
2129 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2130 top_y = s->y;
2131 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2132
2133 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2134 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2135 && (s->prev == NULL
2136 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2137 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2138 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2139 && (s->next == NULL
2140 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2141
2142 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2143
2144 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2145 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2146 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2147 else
2148 {
2149 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2150 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2151 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2152 }
2153 }
2154
2155
2156 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2157
2158 static void
2159 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2160 {
2161 int x = s->x;
2162 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2163
2164 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2165 right of that line. */
2166 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2167 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2168 && s->slice.x == 0)
2169 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2170
2171 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2172 by that margin. */
2173 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2174 x += s->img->hmargin;
2175 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2176 y += s->img->vmargin;
2177
2178 if (s->img->pixmap)
2179 {
2180 if (s->img->mask)
2181 {
2182 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2183 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2184 trust on the shape extension to be available
2185 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2186 manually. */
2187 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2188 | GCFunction);
2189 XGCValues xgcv;
2190 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2191
2192 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2193 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2194 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2195 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2196 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2197
2198 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2199 image_rect.x = x;
2200 image_rect.y = y;
2201 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2202 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2203 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2204 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2205 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2206 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2207 }
2208 else
2209 {
2210 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2211
2212 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2213 image_rect.x = x;
2214 image_rect.y = y;
2215 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2216 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2217 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2218 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2219 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2220 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2221
2222 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2223 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2224 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2225 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2226 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2227 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2228 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2229 {
2230 int relief = s->img->relief;
2231 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2232 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2233 x - relief, y - relief,
2234 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2235 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2236 }
2237 }
2238 }
2239 else
2240 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2241 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2242 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2243 }
2244
2245
2246 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2247
2248 static void
2249 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2250 {
2251 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2252 XRectangle r;
2253 int x = s->x;
2254 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2255
2256 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2257 right of that line. */
2258 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2259 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2260 && s->slice.x == 0)
2261 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2262
2263 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2264 by that margin. */
2265 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2266 x += s->img->hmargin;
2267 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2268 y += s->img->vmargin;
2269
2270 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2271 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2272 {
2273 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2274 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2275 }
2276 else
2277 {
2278 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2279 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2280 }
2281
2282 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2283 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2284
2285 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2286 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2287 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2288 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2289
2290 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2291 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2292 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2293 s->slice.y == 0,
2294 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2295 s->slice.x == 0,
2296 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2297 &r);
2298 }
2299
2300
2301 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2302
2303 static void
2304 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2305 {
2306 int x = 0;
2307 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2308
2309 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2310 right of that line. */
2311 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2312 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2313 && s->slice.x == 0)
2314 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2315
2316 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2317 by that margin. */
2318 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2319 x += s->img->hmargin;
2320 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2321 y += s->img->vmargin;
2322
2323 if (s->img->pixmap)
2324 {
2325 if (s->img->mask)
2326 {
2327 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2328 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2329 trust on the shape extension to be available
2330 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2331 manually. */
2332 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2333 | GCFunction);
2334 XGCValues xgcv;
2335
2336 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2337 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2338 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2339 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2340 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2341
2342 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2343 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2344 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2345 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2346 }
2347 else
2348 {
2349 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2350 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2351 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2352
2353 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2354 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2355 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2356 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2357 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2358 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2359 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2360 {
2361 int r = s->img->relief;
2362 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2364 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2365 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2366 }
2367 }
2368 }
2369 else
2370 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2371 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2372 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2373 }
2374
2375
2376 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2377 give the rectangle to draw. */
2378
2379 static void
2380 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2381 {
2382 if (s->stippled_p)
2383 {
2384 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2385 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2386 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2387 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2388 }
2389 else
2390 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2391 }
2392
2393
2394 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2395
2396 s->y
2397 s->x +-------------------------
2398 | s->face->box
2399 |
2400 | +-------------------------
2401 | | s->img->margin
2402 | |
2403 | | +-------------------
2404 | | | the image
2405
2406 */
2407
2408 static void
2409 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2410 {
2411 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2412 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2413 int height;
2414 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2415
2416 height = s->height;
2417 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2418 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2419 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2420 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2421
2422 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2423 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2424 flickering. */
2425 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2426 if (height > s->slice.height
2427 || s->img->hmargin
2428 || s->img->vmargin
2429 || s->img->mask
2430 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2431 || s->width != s->background_width)
2432 {
2433 if (s->img->mask)
2434 {
2435 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2436 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2437 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2438 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2439 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2440
2441 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2442 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2443 s->background_width,
2444 s->height, depth);
2445
2446 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2447 pixmap. */
2448 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2449
2450 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2451 if (s->stippled_p)
2452 {
2453 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2454 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2455 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2456 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2457 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2458 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2459 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2460 }
2461 else
2462 {
2463 XGCValues xgcv;
2464 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2465 &xgcv);
2466 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2467 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2468 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2469 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2470 }
2471 }
2472 else
2473 {
2474 int x = s->x;
2475 int y = s->y;
2476
2477 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2478 && s->slice.x == 0)
2479 x += box_line_hwidth;
2480
2481 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2482 y += box_line_vwidth;
2483
2484 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2485 }
2486
2487 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2488 }
2489
2490 /* Draw the foreground. */
2491 if (pixmap != None)
2492 {
2493 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2494 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2495 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2496 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2497 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2498 }
2499 else
2500 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2501
2502 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2503 if (s->img->relief
2504 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2505 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2506 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2507 }
2508
2509
2510 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2511
2512 static void
2513 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2514 {
2515 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2516
2517 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2518 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2519 {
2520 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2521 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2522 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2523 int x = s->x;
2524
2525 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2526 {
2527 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2528
2529 if (x < left_x)
2530 {
2531 background_width -= left_x - x;
2532 x = left_x;
2533 }
2534 }
2535 else
2536 {
2537 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2538 stretch glyph. */
2539 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2540
2541 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2542 background_width -= x - right_x;
2543 x += background_width;
2544 }
2545 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2546 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2547 x -= width;
2548
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2551
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < background_width)
2554 {
2555 int y = s->y;
2556 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2559
2560 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2561 x += width;
2562 else
2563 x = s->x;
2564 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2565 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2566 {
2567 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2568 gc = s->gc;
2569 }
2570 else
2571 gc = s->face->gc;
2572
2573 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2574 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2575
2576 if (s->face->stipple)
2577 {
2578 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2579 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2580 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2581 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2582 }
2583 else
2584 {
2585 XGCValues xgcv;
2586 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2587 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2588 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2589 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2590 }
2591 }
2592 }
2593 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2594 {
2595 int background_width = s->background_width;
2596 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2597
2598 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2599 except for header line and mode line. */
2600 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2601 {
2602 background_width -= left_x - x;
2603 x = left_x;
2604 }
2605 if (background_width > 0)
2606 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2607 }
2608
2609 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2610 }
2611
2612
2613 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2614
2615 static void
2616 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2617 {
2618 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2619
2620 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2621 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2622 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2623 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2624 {
2625 int width;
2626 struct glyph_string *next;
2627
2628 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2629 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2630 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2631 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2632 {
2633 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2635 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2636 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2637 else
2638 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2639 next->num_clips = 0;
2640 }
2641 }
2642
2643 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2644 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2645
2646 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2647 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2648 if (!s->for_overlaps
2649 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2650 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2651 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2652
2653 {
2654 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2655 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2656 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2657 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2658 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2659 }
2660 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2661 && !s->clip_tail
2662 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2663 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2664 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2665 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2666 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2667 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2668 else
2669 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2670
2671 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2672 {
2673 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2674 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2675 break;
2676
2677 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2678 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2679 break;
2680
2681 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2682 if (s->for_overlaps)
2683 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2684 else
2685 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2686 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2687 break;
2688
2689 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2690 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2691 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2692 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2693 else
2694 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2695 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2696 break;
2697
2698 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2699 if (s->for_overlaps)
2700 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2701 else
2702 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2703 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2704 break;
2705
2706 default:
2707 abort ();
2708 }
2709
2710 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2711 {
2712 /* Draw underline. */
2713 if (s->face->underline_p)
2714 {
2715 unsigned long thickness, position;
2716 int y;
2717
2718 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2719 {
2720 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2721 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2722 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2723 }
2724 else
2725 {
2726 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2727 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2728 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2729 else
2730 thickness = 1;
2731 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2732 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2733 else
2734 {
2735 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2736 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2737 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2738 specs, and its default is
2739
2740 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2741 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2742
2743 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2744 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2745 position = s->font->underline_position;
2746 else if (s->font)
2747 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2748 else
2749 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2750 }
2751 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2752 }
2753 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2754 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2755 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2756 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2757 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2758 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2759 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2760 s->underline_position = position;
2761 y = s->ybase + position;
2762 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2763 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2764 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2765 else
2766 {
2767 XGCValues xgcv;
2768 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2769 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2770 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2771 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2772 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2773 }
2774 }
2775
2776 /* Draw overline. */
2777 if (s->face->overline_p)
2778 {
2779 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2780
2781 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2782 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2783 s->width, h);
2784 else
2785 {
2786 XGCValues xgcv;
2787 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2788 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2789 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2790 s->width, h);
2791 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2792 }
2793 }
2794
2795 /* Draw strike-through. */
2796 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2797 {
2798 unsigned long h = 1;
2799 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2800
2801 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2802 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2803 s->width, h);
2804 else
2805 {
2806 XGCValues xgcv;
2807 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2808 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2809 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2810 s->width, h);
2811 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2812 }
2813 }
2814
2815 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2816 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2817 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2818
2819 if (s->prev)
2820 {
2821 struct glyph_string *prev;
2822
2823 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2824 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2825 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2826 {
2827 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2828 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2829 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2830
2831 prev->hl = s->hl;
2832 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2833 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2834 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2835 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2836 else
2837 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2838 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2839 prev->hl = save;
2840 prev->num_clips = 0;
2841 }
2842 }
2843
2844 if (s->next)
2845 {
2846 struct glyph_string *next;
2847
2848 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2849 if (next->hl != s->hl
2850 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2851 {
2852 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2853 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2854 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2855
2856 next->hl = s->hl;
2857 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2858 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2859 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2860 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2861 else
2862 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2863 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2864 next->hl = save;
2865 next->num_clips = 0;
2866 }
2867 }
2868 }
2869
2870 /* Reset clipping. */
2871 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2872 s->num_clips = 0;
2873 }
2874
2875 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2876
2877 static void
2878 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2879 {
2880 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2881 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2882 x, y, width, height,
2883 x + shift_by, y);
2884 }
2885
2886 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2887 for X frames. */
2888
2889 static void
2890 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2891 {
2892 abort ();
2893 }
2894
2895
2896 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2897 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2898
2899 void
2900 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2901 {
2902 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2903 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2904 }
2905
2906
2907 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2908
2909 static void
2910 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2911 {
2912 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2913 longer visible. */
2914 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2915 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2916 output_cursor.x = -1;
2917
2918 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2919 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2920 BLOCK_INPUT;
2921
2922 /* The following call is commented out because it does not seem to accomplish
2923 anything, apart from causing flickering during window resize. */
2924 /* XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f)); */
2925
2926 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2927 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2928 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2929
2930 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2931 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2932 redisplay, do it here. */
2933 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2934 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2935 #endif
2936
2937 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2938
2939 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2940 }
2941
2942
2943 \f
2944 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2945
2946 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2947 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2948
2949 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2950
2951
2952 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2953 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2954
2955 static int
2956 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2957 {
2958 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2959 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2960 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2961 {
2962 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2963 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2964 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2965 }
2966
2967 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2968 {
2969 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2970 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2971 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2972 }
2973
2974 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2975 positive. */
2976 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2977 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2978
2979 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2980 negative. */
2981 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2982 }
2983
2984 static void
2985 XTflash (struct frame *f)
2986 {
2987 BLOCK_INPUT;
2988
2989 {
2990 #ifdef USE_GTK
2991 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2992 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
2993 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2994 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
2995 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
2996 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
2997 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
2998 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
2999 do { \
3000 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3001 cairo_fill (cr); \
3002 } \
3003 while (0)
3004 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3005 GdkGCValues vals;
3006 GdkGC *gc;
3007 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3008 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3009 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3010 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3011 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3012 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3013 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3014 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3015 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3016 GC gc;
3017
3018 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3019 pixels into background pixels. */
3020 {
3021 XGCValues values;
3022
3023 values.function = GXxor;
3024 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3025 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3026
3027 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3028 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3029 }
3030 #endif
3031 {
3032 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3033 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3034 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3035 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3036 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3037 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3038 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3039
3040 int width;
3041
3042 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3043 edge it is next to. */
3044 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3045 {
3046 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3047 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3048 break;
3049
3050 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3051 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3052 break;
3053
3054 default:
3055 break;
3056 }
3057
3058 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3059
3060 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3061 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3062 {
3063 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3064 flash_left,
3065 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3066 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3067 width, flash_height);
3068 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3069 flash_left,
3070 (height - flash_height
3071 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3072 width, flash_height);
3073
3074 }
3075 else
3076 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3077 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3078 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3079 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3080
3081 x_flush (f);
3082
3083 {
3084 struct timeval wakeup;
3085
3086 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3087
3088 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3089 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3090 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3091 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3092
3093 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3094 available. */
3095 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3096 {
3097 struct timeval current;
3098 struct timeval timeout;
3099
3100 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3101
3102 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3103 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3104 break;
3105
3106 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3107 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3108 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3109
3110 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3111 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3112 }
3113 }
3114
3115 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3116 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3117 {
3118 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3119 flash_left,
3120 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3121 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3122 width, flash_height);
3123 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3124 flash_left,
3125 (height - flash_height
3126 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3127 width, flash_height);
3128 }
3129 else
3130 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3131 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3132 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3133 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3134
3135 #ifdef USE_GTK
3136 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3137 cairo_destroy (cr);
3138 #else
3139 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3140 #endif
3141 #undef XFillRectangle
3142 #else
3143 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3144 #endif
3145 x_flush (f);
3146 }
3147 }
3148
3149 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3150 }
3151
3152 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3153
3154
3155 static void
3156 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3157 {
3158 BLOCK_INPUT;
3159 if (invisible)
3160 {
3161 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3162 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3163 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3164 }
3165 else
3166 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3167 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3168 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3169 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3170 }
3171
3172
3173 /* Make audible bell. */
3174
3175 static void
3176 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3177 {
3178 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3179 {
3180 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3181 if (visible_bell)
3182 XTflash (f);
3183 else
3184 #endif
3185 {
3186 BLOCK_INPUT;
3187 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3188 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3189 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3190 }
3191 }
3192 }
3193
3194 \f
3195 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3196 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3197 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3198 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3199
3200 static void
3201 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3202 {
3203 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3204 }
3205
3206
3207 \f
3208 /***********************************************************************
3209 Line Dance
3210 ***********************************************************************/
3211
3212 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3213 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3214
3215 static void
3216 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3217 {
3218 abort ();
3219 }
3220
3221
3222 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3223
3224 static void
3225 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3226 {
3227 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3228 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3229
3230 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3231 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3232 fringe of W. */
3233 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3234
3235 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3236 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3237 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3238 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3239 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3240 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3241 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3242 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3243 {
3244 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3245
3246 if (sb_width > 0)
3247 {
3248 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3249 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3250 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3251
3252 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3253 {
3254 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3255 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3256 }
3257 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3258 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3259 }
3260 }
3261 #endif
3262
3263 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3264 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3265 bottom_y = y + height;
3266
3267 if (to_y < from_y)
3268 {
3269 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3270 line at the bottom. */
3271 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3272 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3273 else
3274 height = run->height;
3275 }
3276 else
3277 {
3278 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3279 at the bottom. */
3280 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3281 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3282 else
3283 height = run->height;
3284 }
3285
3286 BLOCK_INPUT;
3287
3288 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3289 updated_window = w;
3290 x_clear_cursor (w);
3291
3292 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3293 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3294 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3295 x, from_y,
3296 width, height,
3297 x, to_y);
3298
3299 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3300 }
3301
3302
3303 \f
3304 /***********************************************************************
3305 Exposure Events
3306 ***********************************************************************/
3307
3308 \f
3309 static void
3310 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3311 {
3312 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3313 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3314 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3315 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3316 BLOCK_INPUT;
3317 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3318 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3319 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3320 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3321 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3322 }
3323
3324 static void
3325 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3326 {
3327 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3328 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3329 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3330 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3331 BLOCK_INPUT;
3332 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3333 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3334 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3335 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3336 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3337 }
3338
3339 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3340 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3341 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3342 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3343 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3344
3345 static void
3346 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3347 {
3348 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3349
3350 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3351 {
3352 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3353 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3354 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3355
3356 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3357 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3358
3359 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3360 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3361 else
3362 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3363 }
3364
3365 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3366 }
3367
3368 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3369 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3370 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3371
3372 static void
3373 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3374 {
3375 if (type == FocusIn)
3376 {
3377 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3378 {
3379 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3380 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3381
3382 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3383 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3384 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3385 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3386 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3387 {
3388 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3389 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3390 }
3391 }
3392
3393 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3394
3395 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3396 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3397 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3398 #endif
3399 }
3400 else if (type == FocusOut)
3401 {
3402 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3403
3404 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3405 {
3406 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3407 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3408 }
3409
3410 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3411 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3412 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3413 #endif
3414 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3415 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3416 }
3417 }
3418
3419 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3420 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3421
3422 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3423
3424 static void
3425 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3426 {
3427 struct frame *frame;
3428
3429 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3430 if (! frame)
3431 return;
3432
3433 switch (event->type)
3434 {
3435 case EnterNotify:
3436 case LeaveNotify:
3437 {
3438 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3439 int focus_state
3440 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3441
3442 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3443 && event->xcrossing.focus
3444 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3445 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3446 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3447 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3448 }
3449 break;
3450
3451 case FocusIn:
3452 case FocusOut:
3453 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3454 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3455 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3456 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3457 break;
3458
3459 case ClientMessage:
3460 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3461 {
3462 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3463 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3464 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3465 }
3466 break;
3467 }
3468 }
3469
3470
3471 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3472 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3473
3474 void
3475 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3476 {
3477 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3478 }
3479 #endif
3480
3481 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3482 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3483 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3484
3485 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3486 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3487 the appropriate X display info. */
3488
3489 static void
3490 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3491 {
3492 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3493 }
3494
3495 static void
3496 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3497 {
3498 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3499
3500 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3501 {
3502 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3503 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3504 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3505 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3506 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3507 {
3508 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3509 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3510 }
3511 }
3512 else
3513 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3514
3515 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3516 {
3517 if (old_highlight)
3518 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3519 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3520 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3521 }
3522 }
3523
3524
3525 \f
3526 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3527
3528 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3529 static void
3530 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3531 {
3532 int min_code, max_code;
3533 KeySym *syms;
3534 int syms_per_code;
3535 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3536
3537 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3538 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3539 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3540 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3541 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3542
3543 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3544
3545 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3546 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3547 &syms_per_code);
3548 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3549
3550 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3551 Alt keysyms are on. */
3552 {
3553 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3554 int found_alt_or_meta;
3555
3556 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3557 {
3558 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3559 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3560 {
3561 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3562
3563 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3564 if (code == 0)
3565 continue;
3566
3567 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3568 {
3569 int code_col;
3570
3571 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3572 {
3573 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3574
3575 switch (sym)
3576 {
3577 case XK_Meta_L:
3578 case XK_Meta_R:
3579 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3580 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3581 break;
3582
3583 case XK_Alt_L:
3584 case XK_Alt_R:
3585 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3586 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3587 break;
3588
3589 case XK_Hyper_L:
3590 case XK_Hyper_R:
3591 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3592 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3593 code_col = syms_per_code;
3594 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3595 break;
3596
3597 case XK_Super_L:
3598 case XK_Super_R:
3599 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3600 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3601 code_col = syms_per_code;
3602 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3603 break;
3604
3605 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3606 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3607 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3608 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3609 code_col = syms_per_code;
3610 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3611 break;
3612 }
3613 }
3614 }
3615 }
3616 }
3617 }
3618
3619 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3620 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3621 {
3622 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3623 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3624 }
3625
3626 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3627 make them just meta, not alt. */
3628 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3629 {
3630 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3631 }
3632
3633 XFree ((char *) syms);
3634 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3635 }
3636
3637 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3638 Emacs uses. */
3639
3640 unsigned int
3641 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3642 {
3643 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3644 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3645 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3646 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3647 Lisp_Object tem;
3648
3649 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3650 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3651 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3652 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3653 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3654 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3655 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3656 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3657
3658
3659 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3660 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3661 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3662 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3663 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3664 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3665 }
3666
3667 static unsigned int
3668 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3669 {
3670 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3671 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3672 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3673 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3674
3675 Lisp_Object tem;
3676
3677 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3678 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3679 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3680 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3681 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3682 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3683 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3684 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3685
3686
3687 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3688 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3689 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3690 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3691 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3692 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3693 }
3694
3695 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3696
3697 char *
3698 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3699 {
3700 char *value;
3701
3702 BLOCK_INPUT;
3703 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3704 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3705
3706 return value;
3707 }
3708
3709
3710 \f
3711 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3712
3713 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3714
3715 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3716 the mouse. */
3717
3718 static Lisp_Object
3719 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3720 {
3721 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3722 otherwise. */
3723 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3724 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3725 result->timestamp = event->time;
3726 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3727 event->state)
3728 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3729 ? up_modifier
3730 : down_modifier));
3731
3732 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3733 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3734 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3735 result->arg = Qnil;
3736 return Qnil;
3737 }
3738
3739 \f
3740 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3741 The input handler calls this.
3742
3743 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3744 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3745 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3746 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3747
3748 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3749 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3750
3751 static int
3752 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3753 {
3754 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3755 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3756 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3757
3758 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3759 return 0;
3760
3761 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3762 {
3763 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3764 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3765 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3766 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3767 return 1;
3768 }
3769
3770
3771 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3772 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3773 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3774 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3775 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3776 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3777 {
3778 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3779 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3780 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3781 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3782 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3783 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3784 return 1;
3785 }
3786
3787 return 0;
3788 }
3789
3790 \f
3791 /************************************************************************
3792 Mouse Face
3793 ************************************************************************/
3794
3795 static void
3796 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3797 {
3798 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3799 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3800 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3801 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3802 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3803 }
3804
3805
3806
3807 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3808 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3809
3810 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3811 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3812 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3813 position on the scroll bar.
3814
3815 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3816 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3817 the mouse is over.
3818
3819 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3820 was at this position.
3821
3822 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3823
3824 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3825 movement. */
3826
3827 static void
3828 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3829 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3830 long unsigned int *timestamp)
3831 {
3832 FRAME_PTR f1;
3833
3834 BLOCK_INPUT;
3835
3836 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3837 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3838 else
3839 {
3840 Window root;
3841 int root_x, root_y;
3842
3843 Window dummy_window;
3844 int dummy;
3845
3846 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3847
3848 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3849 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3850 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3851 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3852 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3853
3854 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3855
3856 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3857 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3858 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3859
3860 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3861 &root,
3862
3863 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3864 a different screen. */
3865 &dummy_window,
3866
3867 /* The position on that root window. */
3868 &root_x, &root_y,
3869
3870 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3871 &dummy, &dummy,
3872
3873 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3874 we don't care. */
3875 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3876
3877 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3878 containing the pointer. */
3879 {
3880 Window win, child;
3881 int win_x, win_y;
3882 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3883
3884 win = root;
3885
3886 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3887 structure is changing at the same time this function
3888 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3889
3890 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3891
3892 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3893 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3894 {
3895 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3896 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3897 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3898
3899 /* From-window, to-window. */
3900 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3901
3902 /* From-position, to-position. */
3903 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3904
3905 /* Child of win. */
3906 &child);
3907 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3908 }
3909 else
3910 {
3911 while (1)
3912 {
3913 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3914
3915 /* From-window, to-window. */
3916 root, win,
3917
3918 /* From-position, to-position. */
3919 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3920
3921 /* Child of win. */
3922 &child);
3923
3924 if (child == None || child == win)
3925 break;
3926 #ifdef USE_GTK
3927 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3928 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3929 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3930 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3931 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3932 break;
3933 #endif
3934 win = child;
3935 parent_x = win_x;
3936 parent_y = win_y;
3937 }
3938
3939 /* Now we know that:
3940 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3941 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3942 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3943 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3944 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3945 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3946 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3947 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3948 never use them in that case.) */
3949
3950 #ifdef USE_GTK
3951 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3952 want the edit window. */
3953 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3954 #else
3955 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3956 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3957 #endif
3958
3959 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3960 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3961 on the frame. */
3962 if (f1 != NULL
3963 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3964 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3965 f1 = NULL;
3966 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3967 }
3968
3969 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3970 f1 = 0;
3971
3972 x_uncatch_errors ();
3973
3974 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3975 if (! f1)
3976 {
3977 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3978
3979 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3980
3981 if (bar)
3982 {
3983 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3984 win_x = parent_x;
3985 win_y = parent_y;
3986 }
3987 }
3988
3989 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3990 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3991
3992 if (f1)
3993 {
3994 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3995 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3996 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3997 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3998 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3999 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4000 the frame are divided into. */
4001
4002 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4003 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4004
4005 *bar_window = Qnil;
4006 *part = 0;
4007 *fp = f1;
4008 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4009 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4010 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4011 }
4012 }
4013 }
4014
4015 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4016 }
4017
4018
4019 \f
4020 /***********************************************************************
4021 Scroll bars
4022 ***********************************************************************/
4023
4024 /* Scroll bar support. */
4025
4026 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4027 manages it.
4028 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4029 bits. */
4030
4031 static struct scroll_bar *
4032 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4033 {
4034 Lisp_Object tail;
4035
4036 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4037 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4038 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4039
4040 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4041 {
4042 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4043
4044 frame = XCAR (tail);
4045 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4046 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4047 abort ();
4048
4049 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4050 continue;
4051
4052 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4053 right window ID. */
4054 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4055 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4056 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4057 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4058 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4059 condemned = Qnil,
4060 ! NILP (bar));
4061 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4062 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4063 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4064 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4065 }
4066
4067 return NULL;
4068 }
4069
4070
4071 #if defined USE_LUCID
4072
4073 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4074 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4075
4076 static Widget
4077 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4078 {
4079 Lisp_Object tail;
4080
4081 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4082 {
4083 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4084 {
4085 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4086 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4087
4088 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4089 return menu_bar;
4090 }
4091 }
4092
4093 return NULL;
4094 }
4095
4096 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4097
4098 \f
4099 /************************************************************************
4100 Toolkit scroll bars
4101 ************************************************************************/
4102
4103 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4104
4105 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4106 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4107 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4108 struct scroll_bar *);
4109 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4110 int, int, int);
4111
4112
4113 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4114 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4115
4116 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4117
4118 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4119
4120 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4121
4122 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4123 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4124
4125 #ifndef USE_GTK
4126 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4127
4128 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4129
4130 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4131
4132 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4133 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4134 to avoid jerkyness. */
4135
4136 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4137
4138 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4139 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4140 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4141 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4142
4143 static void
4144 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4145 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4146 {
4147 int scroll_bar_p;
4148 const char *end_action;
4149
4150 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4151 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4152 end_action = "Release";
4153 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4154 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4155 end_action = "EndScroll";
4156 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4157
4158 if (scroll_bar_p
4159 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4160 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4161 {
4162 struct window *w;
4163
4164 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4165 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4166 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4167
4168 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4169 {
4170 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4171 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4172 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4173 }
4174 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4175 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4176
4177 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4178 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4179 }
4180 }
4181 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4182
4183 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4184 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4185
4186 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4187 static size_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4188
4189
4190 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4191 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4192 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4193 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4194
4195 static void
4196 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4197 {
4198 XEvent event;
4199 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4200 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4201 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4202 size_t i;
4203
4204 BLOCK_INPUT;
4205
4206 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4207 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4208 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4209 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4210 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4211 ev->format = 32;
4212
4213 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4214 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4215 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4216 into that array in the event. */
4217 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4218 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4219 break;
4220
4221 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4222 {
4223 size_t new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4224 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4225 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4226
4227 if ((size_t) -1 / sizeof *scroll_bar_windows < new_size)
4228 memory_full ();
4229 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4230 nbytes);
4231 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4232 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4233 }
4234
4235 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4236 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4237 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4238 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4239 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4240 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4241
4242 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4243 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4244 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4245 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4246 #endif
4247
4248 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4249 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4250 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4251 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4252 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4253 }
4254
4255
4256 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4257 in *IEVENT. */
4258
4259 static void
4260 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4261 {
4262 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4263 Lisp_Object window;
4264 struct window *w;
4265
4266 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4267 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4268
4269 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4270
4271 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4272 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4273 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4274 #ifdef USE_GTK
4275 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4276 #else
4277 ievent->timestamp =
4278 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4279 #endif
4280 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4281 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4282 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4283 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4284 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4285 }
4286
4287
4288 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4289
4290 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4291
4292 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4293
4294
4295 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4296 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4297 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4298
4299 static void
4300 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4301 {
4302 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4303 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4304 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4305
4306 switch (cs->reason)
4307 {
4308 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4309 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4310 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4311 break;
4312
4313 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4314 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4315 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4316 break;
4317
4318 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4319 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4320 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4321 break;
4322
4323 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4324 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4325 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4326 break;
4327
4328 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4329 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4330 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4331 break;
4332
4333 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4334 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4335 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4336 break;
4337
4338 case XmCR_DRAG:
4339 {
4340 int slider_size;
4341
4342 /* Get the slider size. */
4343 BLOCK_INPUT;
4344 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4345 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4346
4347 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4348 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4349 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4350 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4351 }
4352 break;
4353
4354 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4355 break;
4356 };
4357
4358 if (part >= 0)
4359 {
4360 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4361 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4362 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4363 }
4364 }
4365
4366 #elif defined USE_GTK
4367
4368 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4369 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4370
4371 static gboolean
4372 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4373 GtkScrollType scroll,
4374 gdouble value,
4375 gpointer user_data)
4376 {
4377 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4378 gdouble position;
4379 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4380 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4381 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4382
4383 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4384 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4385
4386
4387 switch (scroll)
4388 {
4389 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4390 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4391 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4392 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4393 {
4394 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4395 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4396 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4397 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4398 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4399 }
4400 break;
4401 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4402 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4403 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4404 break;
4405 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4406 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4407 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4408 break;
4409 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4410 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4411 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4412 break;
4413 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4414 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4415 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4416 break;
4417 }
4418
4419 if (part >= 0)
4420 {
4421 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4422 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4423 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4424 }
4425
4426 return FALSE;
4427 }
4428
4429 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4430
4431 static gboolean
4432 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4433 GdkEventButton *event,
4434 gpointer user_data)
4435 {
4436 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4437 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4438 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4439 {
4440 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4441 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4442 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4443 }
4444
4445 return FALSE;
4446 }
4447
4448
4449 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4450
4451 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4452 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4453 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4454 the thumb is. */
4455
4456 static void
4457 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4458 {
4459 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4460 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4461 float shown;
4462 int whole, portion, height;
4463 int part;
4464
4465 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4466 BLOCK_INPUT;
4467 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4468 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4469
4470 whole = 10000000;
4471 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4472
4473 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4474 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4475 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4476 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4477 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4478 bottom). */
4479 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4480 else
4481 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4482
4483 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4484 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4485 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4486 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4487 }
4488
4489
4490 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4491 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4492 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4493 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4494 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4495 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4496 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4497
4498 static void
4499 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4500 {
4501 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4502 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4503 int position = (long) call_data;
4504 Dimension height;
4505 int part;
4506
4507 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4508 BLOCK_INPUT;
4509 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4511
4512 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4513 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4514
4515 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4516 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4517 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4518 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4519 else
4520 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4521
4522 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4523 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4524 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4525 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4526 }
4527
4528 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4529
4530 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4531
4532 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4533 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4534
4535 #ifdef USE_GTK
4536 static void
4537 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4538 {
4539 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4540
4541 BLOCK_INPUT;
4542 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4543 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4544 scroll_bar_name);
4545 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4546 }
4547
4548 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4549
4550 static void
4551 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4552 {
4553 Window xwindow;
4554 Widget widget;
4555 Arg av[20];
4556 int ac = 0;
4557 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4558 unsigned long pixel;
4559
4560 BLOCK_INPUT;
4561
4562 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4563 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4564 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4565 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4566 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4567 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4568 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4569 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4570 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4571
4572 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4573 if (pixel != -1)
4574 {
4575 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4576 ++ac;
4577 }
4578
4579 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4580 if (pixel != -1)
4581 {
4582 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4583 ++ac;
4584 }
4585
4586 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4587 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4588
4589 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4590 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4591 (XtPointer) bar);
4592 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4593 (XtPointer) bar);
4594 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4595 (XtPointer) bar);
4596 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4597 (XtPointer) bar);
4598 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4599 (XtPointer) bar);
4600 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4601 (XtPointer) bar);
4602 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4603 (XtPointer) bar);
4604
4605 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4606 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4607
4608 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4609 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4610 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4611 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4612
4613 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4614
4615 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4616 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4617 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4618 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4619 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4620 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4621 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4622 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4623
4624 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4625 if (pixel != -1)
4626 {
4627 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4628 ++ac;
4629 }
4630
4631 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4632 if (pixel != -1)
4633 {
4634 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4635 ++ac;
4636 }
4637
4638 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4639
4640 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4641 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4642 {
4643 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4644 if (pixel != -1)
4645 {
4646 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4647 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4648 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4649 pixel = -1;
4650 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4651 }
4652 }
4653 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4654 {
4655 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4656 if (pixel != -1)
4657 {
4658 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4659 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4660 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4661 pixel = -1;
4662 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4663 }
4664 }
4665
4666 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4667 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4668 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4669 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4670 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4671 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4672 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4673 colors itself. */
4674 {
4675 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4676 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4677 ++ac;
4678 }
4679 else
4680 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4681 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4682 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4683 {
4684 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4685 the shadows. */
4686 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4687 ++ac;
4688
4689 /* Specify the colors. */
4690 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4691 if (pixel != -1)
4692 {
4693 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4694 ++ac;
4695 }
4696 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4697 if (pixel != -1)
4698 {
4699 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4700 ++ac;
4701 }
4702 }
4703 #endif
4704
4705 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4706 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4707
4708 {
4709 char const *initial = "";
4710 char const *val = initial;
4711 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4712 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4713 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4714 #endif
4715 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4716 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4717 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4718 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4719 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4720 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4721 }
4722 }
4723
4724 /* Define callbacks. */
4725 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4726 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4727 (XtPointer) bar);
4728
4729 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4730 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4731
4732 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4733
4734 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4735 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4736 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4737 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4738
4739 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4740 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4741 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4742 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4743
4744 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4745 }
4746 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4747
4748
4749 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4750 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4751
4752 #ifdef USE_GTK
4753 static void
4754 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4755 {
4756 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4757 }
4758
4759 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4760 static void
4761 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4762 int whole)
4763 {
4764 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4765 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4766 float top, shown;
4767
4768 BLOCK_INPUT;
4769
4770 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4771
4772 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4773 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4774 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4775 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4776 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4777 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4778 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4779 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4780 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4781 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4782 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4783 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4784 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4785 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4786 whole += portion;
4787
4788 if (whole <= 0)
4789 top = 0, shown = 1;
4790 else
4791 {
4792 top = (float) position / whole;
4793 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4794 }
4795
4796 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4797 {
4798 int size, value;
4799
4800 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4801 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4802 value. */
4803 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4804 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4805 size = max (size, 1);
4806
4807 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4808 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4809 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4810
4811 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4812 }
4813 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4814
4815 if (whole == 0)
4816 top = 0, shown = 1;
4817 else
4818 {
4819 top = (float) position / whole;
4820 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4821 }
4822
4823 {
4824 float old_top, old_shown;
4825 Dimension height;
4826 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4827 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4828 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4829 XtNheight, &height,
4830 NULL);
4831
4832 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4833 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4834 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4835 else
4836 top = old_top;
4837 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4838 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4839
4840 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4841 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4842 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4843 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4844 {
4845 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4846 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4847 else
4848 {
4849 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4850 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4851 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4852
4853 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4854 }
4855 }
4856 }
4857 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4858
4859 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4860 }
4861 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4862
4863 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4864
4865
4866 \f
4867 /************************************************************************
4868 Scroll bars, general
4869 ************************************************************************/
4870
4871 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4872 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4873 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4874 scroll bar. */
4875
4876 static struct scroll_bar *
4877 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4878 {
4879 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4880 struct scroll_bar *bar
4881 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4882
4883 BLOCK_INPUT;
4884
4885 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4886 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4887 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4888 {
4889 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4890 unsigned long mask;
4891 Window window;
4892
4893 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4894 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4895 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4896
4897 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4898 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4899 | ExposureMask);
4900 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4901
4902 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4903
4904 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4905 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4906 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4907 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4908 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4909 left, top, width,
4910 window_box_height (w), False);
4911
4912 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4913 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4914 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4915 top,
4916 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4917 height,
4918 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4919 0,
4920 CopyFromParent,
4921 CopyFromParent,
4922 CopyFromParent,
4923 /* Attributes. */
4924 mask, &a);
4925 bar->x_window = window;
4926 }
4927 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4928
4929 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4930 bar->top = top;
4931 bar->left = left;
4932 bar->width = width;
4933 bar->height = height;
4934 bar->start = 0;
4935 bar->end = 0;
4936 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4937 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4938
4939 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4940 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4941 bar->prev = Qnil;
4942 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4943 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4944 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4945
4946 /* Map the window/widget. */
4947 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4948 {
4949 #ifdef USE_GTK
4950 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4951 bar->x_window,
4952 top,
4953 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4954 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4955 max (height, 1));
4956 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4957 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4958 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4959 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4960 top,
4961 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4962 max (height, 1), 0);
4963 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4964 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4965 }
4966 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4967 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4968 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4969
4970 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4971 return bar;
4972 }
4973
4974
4975 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4976
4977 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4978
4979 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4980 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4981 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4982 events.)
4983
4984 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4985 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4986 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4987 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4988 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4989
4990 static void
4991 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4992 {
4993 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4994 Window w = bar->x_window;
4995 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4996 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4997
4998 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4999 if (! rebuild
5000 && start == bar->start
5001 && end == bar->end)
5002 return;
5003
5004 BLOCK_INPUT;
5005
5006 {
5007 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5008 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5009 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5010
5011 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5012 the distance between start and end. */
5013 {
5014 int length = end - start;
5015
5016 if (start < 0)
5017 start = 0;
5018 else if (start > top_range)
5019 start = top_range;
5020 end = start + length;
5021
5022 if (end < start)
5023 end = start;
5024 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5025 end = top_range;
5026 }
5027
5028 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5029 bar->start = start;
5030 bar->end = end;
5031
5032 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5033 if (end > top_range)
5034 end = top_range;
5035
5036 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5037 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5038 that many pixels tall. */
5039 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5040
5041 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5042 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5043 if (0 < start)
5044 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5045 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5046 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5047 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5048 inside_width, start,
5049 False);
5050
5051 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5052 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5053 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5054 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5055
5056 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5057 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5058 /* x, y, width, height */
5059 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5060 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5061 inside_width, end - start);
5062
5063 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5064 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5065 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5066 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5067
5068 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5069 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5070 if (end < inside_height)
5071 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5072 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5073 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5074 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5075 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5076 False);
5077
5078 }
5079
5080 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5081 }
5082
5083 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5084
5085 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5086 nil. */
5087
5088 static void
5089 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5090 {
5091 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5092 BLOCK_INPUT;
5093
5094 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5095 #ifdef USE_GTK
5096 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5097 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5098 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5099 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5100 #else
5101 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5102 #endif
5103
5104 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5105 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5106
5107 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5108 }
5109
5110
5111 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5112 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5113 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5114 create one. */
5115
5116 static void
5117 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5118 {
5119 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5120 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5121 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5122 int window_y, window_height;
5123 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5124 int fringe_extended_p;
5125 #endif
5126
5127 /* Get window dimensions. */
5128 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5129 top = window_y;
5130 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5131 height = window_height;
5132
5133 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5134 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5135
5136 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5137 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5138 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5139 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5140 else
5141 sb_width = width;
5142
5143 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5144 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5145 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5146 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5147 else
5148 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5149 #else
5150 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5151 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5152 else
5153 sb_left = left;
5154 #endif
5155
5156 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5157 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5158 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5159 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5160 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5161 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5162 else
5163 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5164 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5165 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5166 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5167 #endif
5168
5169 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5170 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5171 {
5172 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5173 {
5174 BLOCK_INPUT;
5175 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5176 if (fringe_extended_p)
5177 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5178 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5179 else
5180 #endif
5181 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5182 left, top, width, height, False);
5183 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5184 }
5185
5186 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5187 }
5188 else
5189 {
5190 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5191 unsigned int mask = 0;
5192
5193 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5194
5195 BLOCK_INPUT;
5196
5197 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5198 mask |= CWX;
5199 if (top != bar->top)
5200 mask |= CWY;
5201 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5202 mask |= CWWidth;
5203 if (height != bar->height)
5204 mask |= CWHeight;
5205
5206 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5207
5208 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5209 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5210 {
5211 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5212 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5213 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5214 {
5215 if (fringe_extended_p)
5216 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5217 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5218 else
5219 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5220 left, top, width, height, False);
5221 }
5222 #ifdef USE_GTK
5223 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5224 bar->x_window,
5225 top,
5226 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5227 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5228 max (height, 1));
5229 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5230 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5231 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5232 top,
5233 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5234 max (height, 1), 0);
5235 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5236 }
5237 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5238
5239 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5240 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5241 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5242 {
5243 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5244 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5245 height, False);
5246 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5247 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5248 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5249 height, False);
5250 }
5251
5252 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5253 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5254 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5255 example. */
5256 {
5257 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5258 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5259 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5260 {
5261 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5262 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5263 left + area_width - rest, top,
5264 rest, height, False);
5265 else
5266 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5267 left, top, rest, height, False);
5268 }
5269 }
5270
5271 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5272 if (mask)
5273 {
5274 XWindowChanges wc;
5275
5276 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5277 wc.y = top;
5278 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5279 wc.height = height;
5280 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5281 mask, &wc);
5282 }
5283
5284 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5285
5286 /* Remember new settings. */
5287 bar->left = sb_left;
5288 bar->top = top;
5289 bar->width = sb_width;
5290 bar->height = height;
5291
5292 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5293 }
5294
5295 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5296 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5297
5298 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5299 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5300 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5301 dragged. */
5302 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5303 {
5304 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5305
5306 if (whole == 0)
5307 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5308 else
5309 {
5310 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5311 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5312 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5313 }
5314 }
5315 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5316
5317 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5318 }
5319
5320
5321 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5322 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5323 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5324 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5325 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5326 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5327 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5328
5329 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5330 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5331 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5332
5333 static void
5334 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5335 {
5336 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5337 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5338 {
5339 Lisp_Object bar;
5340 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5341 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5342 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5343 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5344 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5345 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5346 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5347 }
5348 }
5349
5350
5351 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5352 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5353
5354 static void
5355 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5356 {
5357 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5358 struct frame *f;
5359
5360 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5361 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5362 abort ();
5363
5364 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5365
5366 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5367 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5368 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5369 {
5370 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5371 the lists. */
5372 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5373 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5374 return;
5375 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5376 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5377 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5378 else
5379 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5380 one or the other! */
5381 abort ();
5382 }
5383 else
5384 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5385
5386 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5387 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5388
5389 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5390 bar->prev = Qnil;
5391 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5392 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5393 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5394 }
5395
5396 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5397 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5398
5399 static void
5400 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5401 {
5402 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5403
5404 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5405
5406 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5407 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5408 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5409
5410 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5411 {
5412 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5413
5414 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5415
5416 next = b->next;
5417 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5418 }
5419
5420 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5421 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5422 }
5423
5424
5425 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5426 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5427 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5428
5429 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5430 mark bits. */
5431
5432 static void
5433 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5434 {
5435 Window w = bar->x_window;
5436 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5437 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5438 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5439
5440 BLOCK_INPUT;
5441
5442 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5443
5444 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5445 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5446 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5447 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5448
5449 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5450 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5451
5452 /* x, y, width, height */
5453 0, 0,
5454 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5455 bar->height - 1);
5456
5457 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5458 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5459 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5460 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5461
5462 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5463
5464 }
5465 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5466
5467 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5468 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5469
5470 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5471 mark bits. */
5472
5473
5474 static void
5475 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5476 {
5477 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5478 abort ();
5479
5480 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5481 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5482 emacs_event->modifiers
5483 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5484 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5485 event->xbutton.state)
5486 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5487 ? up_modifier
5488 : down_modifier));
5489 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5490 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5491 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5492 {
5493 int top_range
5494 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5495 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5496
5497 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5498 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5499
5500 if (y < bar->start)
5501 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5502 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5503 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5504 else
5505 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5506
5507 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5508 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5509 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5510 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5511 {
5512 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5513 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5514
5515 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5516 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5517 }
5518 #endif
5519
5520 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5521 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5522 }
5523 }
5524
5525 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5526
5527 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5528
5529 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5530 mark bits. */
5531
5532 static void
5533 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5534 {
5535 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5536
5537 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5538
5539 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5540 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5541
5542 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5543 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5544 {
5545 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5546 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5547
5548 if (new_start != bar->start)
5549 {
5550 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5551
5552 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5553 }
5554 }
5555 }
5556
5557 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5558
5559 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5560 on the scroll bar. */
5561
5562 static void
5563 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5564 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5565 Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *timestamp)
5566 {
5567 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5568 Window w = bar->x_window;
5569 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5570 int win_x, win_y;
5571 Window dummy_window;
5572 int dummy_coord;
5573 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5574
5575 BLOCK_INPUT;
5576
5577 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5578 report that. */
5579 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5580
5581 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5582 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5583 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5584
5585 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5586 &win_x, &win_y,
5587
5588 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5589 &dummy_mask))
5590 ;
5591 else
5592 {
5593 int top_range
5594 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5595
5596 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5597
5598 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5599 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5600
5601 if (win_y < 0)
5602 win_y = 0;
5603 if (win_y > top_range)
5604 win_y = top_range;
5605
5606 *fp = f;
5607 *bar_window = bar->window;
5608
5609 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5610 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5611 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5612 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5613 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5614 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5615 else
5616 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5617
5618 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5619 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5620
5621 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5622 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5623 }
5624
5625 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5626
5627 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5628 }
5629
5630
5631 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5632 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5633 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5634 redraw them. */
5635
5636 static void
5637 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5638 {
5639 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5640 Lisp_Object bar;
5641
5642 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5643 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5644 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5645 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5646 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5647 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5648 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5649 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5650 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5651 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5652 }
5653
5654 \f
5655 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5656
5657 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5658 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5659 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5660 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5661
5662 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5663 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5664
5665 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5666
5667 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5668 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5669
5670 static int temp_index;
5671 static short temp_buffer[100];
5672
5673 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5674 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5675 temp_index = 0; \
5676 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5677
5678 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5679 on a particular display. */
5680
5681 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5682
5683 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5684 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5685 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5686 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5687
5688 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5689
5690 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5691 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5692 do \
5693 { \
5694 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5695 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5696 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5697 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5698 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5699 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5700 } \
5701 while (0)
5702 #endif
5703
5704 enum
5705 {
5706 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5707 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5708 X_EVENT_DROP
5709 };
5710
5711 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5712 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5713 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5714
5715 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5716 this event further.
5717 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5718
5719 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5720 static int
5721 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5722 {
5723 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5724 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5725 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5726 was created. */
5727
5728 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5729 event->xclient.window);
5730
5731 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5732 }
5733 #endif
5734
5735 #ifdef USE_GTK
5736 static int current_count;
5737 static int current_finish;
5738 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5739
5740 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5741 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5742 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5743 static GdkFilterReturn
5744 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5745 {
5746 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5747
5748 BLOCK_INPUT;
5749 if (current_count >= 0)
5750 {
5751 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5752
5753 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5754
5755 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5756 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5757 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5758 so we do it here. */
5759 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5760 && dpyinfo
5761 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5762 {
5763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5764 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5765 }
5766 #endif
5767
5768 if (! dpyinfo)
5769 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5770 else
5771 current_count +=
5772 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5773 current_hold_quit);
5774 }
5775 else
5776 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5777
5778 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5779
5780 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5781 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5782
5783 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5784 }
5785 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5786
5787
5788 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5789 enum xembed_message,
5790 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5791
5792 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5793
5794 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5795 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5796 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5797
5798 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5799
5800 static int
5801 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5802 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5803 {
5804 union {
5805 struct input_event ie;
5806 struct selection_input_event sie;
5807 } inev;
5808 int count = 0;
5809 int do_help = 0;
5810 int nbytes = 0;
5811 struct frame *f = NULL;
5812 struct coding_system coding;
5813 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5814 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5815
5816 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5817
5818 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5819 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5820 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5821
5822 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5823 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5824
5825 switch (event.type)
5826 {
5827 case ClientMessage:
5828 {
5829 if (event.xclient.message_type
5830 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5831 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5832 {
5833 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5834 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5835 {
5836 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5837 could be the shell widget window
5838 if the frame has no title bar. */
5839 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5840 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5841 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5842 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5843 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5844 #endif
5845 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5846 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5847 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5848 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5849 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5850 needed.
5851
5852 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5853 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5854 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5855 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5856 Emacs. */
5857
5858 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5859 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5860 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5861 if (f)
5862 {
5863 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5864 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5865 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5866 x_catch_errors (d);
5867 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5868 /* The ICCCM says this is
5869 the only valid choice. */
5870 RevertToParent,
5871 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5872 /* This is needed to detect the error
5873 if there is an error. */
5874 XSync (d, False);
5875 x_uncatch_errors ();
5876 }
5877 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5878 #endif /* 0 */
5879 goto done;
5880 }
5881
5882 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5883 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5884 {
5885 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5886 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5887 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5888 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5889 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5890 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5891 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5892 session manager and one for this. */
5893 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5894 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5895 #endif
5896 {
5897 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5898 event.xclient.window);
5899 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5900 for a single Emacs process. */
5901 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5902 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5903 event.xclient.window,
5904 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5905 else if (f)
5906 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5907 event.xclient.window,
5908 0, 0);
5909 }
5910 goto done;
5911 }
5912
5913 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5914 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5915 {
5916 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5917 event.xclient.window);
5918 if (!f)
5919 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5920
5921 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5922 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5923 goto done;
5924 }
5925
5926 goto done;
5927 }
5928
5929 if (event.xclient.message_type
5930 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5931 {
5932 goto done;
5933 }
5934
5935 if (event.xclient.message_type
5936 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5937 {
5938 int new_x, new_y;
5939 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5940
5941 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5942 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5943
5944 if (f)
5945 {
5946 f->left_pos = new_x;
5947 f->top_pos = new_y;
5948 }
5949 goto done;
5950 }
5951
5952 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5953 if (event.xclient.message_type
5954 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5955 {
5956 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5957 if (f)
5958 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5959 &event, NULL);
5960 goto done;
5961 }
5962 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5963
5964 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5965 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5966 || (event.xclient.message_type
5967 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5968 {
5969 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5970 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5971 currently never do because we are interested in
5972 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5973 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5974 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5975 if (!f)
5976 goto OTHER;
5977 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5978 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5979 goto done;
5980 }
5981
5982 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5983 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5984 we construct an input_event. */
5985 if (event.xclient.message_type
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5987 {
5988 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5989 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5990 goto done;
5991 }
5992 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5993
5994 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5995 if (event.xclient.message_type
5996 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5997 {
5998 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5999 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6000 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6001
6002 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6003 goto done;
6004 }
6005
6006 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6007
6008 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6009 if (!f)
6010 goto OTHER;
6011 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6012 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6013 }
6014 break;
6015
6016 case SelectionNotify:
6017 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6019 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6020 goto OTHER;
6021 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6022 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6023 break;
6024
6025 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6026 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6027 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6028 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6029 goto OTHER;
6030 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6031 {
6032 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6033
6034 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6036 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6037 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6038 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6039 }
6040 break;
6041
6042 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6043 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6044 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6045 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6046 goto OTHER;
6047 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6048 {
6049 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6050
6051 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6052 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6053 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6054 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6055 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6056 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6057 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6058 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6059 }
6060 break;
6061
6062 case PropertyNotify:
6063 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6064 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6065 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6066 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6067
6068 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6069 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6070 goto OTHER;
6071
6072 case ReparentNotify:
6073 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6074 if (f)
6075 {
6076 int x, y;
6077 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6078 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6079 f->left_pos = x;
6080 f->top_pos = y;
6081
6082 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6083 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6084 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6085 }
6086 goto OTHER;
6087
6088 case Expose:
6089 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6090 if (f)
6091 {
6092 #ifdef USE_GTK
6093 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6094 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6095 event.xexpose.window,
6096 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6097 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6098 FALSE);
6099 #endif
6100 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6101 {
6102 f->async_visible = 1;
6103 f->async_iconified = 0;
6104 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6105 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6106 }
6107 else
6108 expose_frame (f,
6109 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6110 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6111 }
6112 else
6113 {
6114 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6115 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6116 #endif
6117 #if defined USE_LUCID
6118 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6119 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6120 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6121 {
6122 Widget widget
6123 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6124 if (widget)
6125 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6126 }
6127 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6128
6129 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6130 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6131 goto OTHER;
6132 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6133 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6134 event.xexpose.window);
6135
6136 if (bar)
6137 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6138 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6139 else
6140 goto OTHER;
6141 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6142 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6143 }
6144 break;
6145
6146 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6147 source area was obscured or not
6148 available. */
6149 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6150 if (f)
6151 {
6152 expose_frame (f,
6153 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6154 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6155 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6156 }
6157 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6158 else
6159 goto OTHER;
6160 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6161 break;
6162
6163 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6164 source area was completely
6165 available. */
6166 break;
6167
6168 case UnmapNotify:
6169 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6170 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6171 {
6172 tip_window = 0;
6173 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6174 }
6175
6176 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6177 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6178 the frame was deleted. */
6179 {
6180 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6181 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6182 display that won't ever be seen. */
6183 f->async_visible = 0;
6184 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6185 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6186 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6187 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6188 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6189 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6190 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6191 {
6192 f->async_iconified = 1;
6193
6194 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6195 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6196 }
6197 }
6198 goto OTHER;
6199
6200 case MapNotify:
6201 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6202 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6203 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6204 goto OTHER;
6205
6206 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6207 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6208 frame is visible. */
6209 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6210 if (f)
6211 {
6212 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6213 the frame's display structures.
6214 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6215 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6216 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6217 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6218 if (! f->async_iconified)
6219 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6220
6221 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6222 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6223 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6224 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6225
6226 f->async_visible = 1;
6227 f->async_iconified = 0;
6228 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6229
6230 if (f->iconified)
6231 {
6232 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6233 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6234 }
6235 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6236 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6237 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6238 to update the frame titles
6239 in case this is the second frame. */
6240 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6241
6242 #ifdef USE_GTK
6243 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6244 #endif
6245 }
6246 goto OTHER;
6247
6248 case KeyPress:
6249
6250 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6251 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6252
6253 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6254 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6255 if (popup_activated ())
6256 goto OTHER;
6257 #endif
6258
6259 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6260
6261 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6262 mouse highlighting. */
6263 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6264 && (f == 0
6265 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6266 {
6267 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6268 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6269 }
6270
6271 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6272 if (f == 0)
6273 {
6274 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6275 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6276 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6277 event.xkey.window);
6278 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6279 {
6280 widget = XtParent (widget);
6281 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6282 }
6283 }
6284 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6285
6286 if (f != 0)
6287 {
6288 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6289 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6290 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6291 his Emacs hang.
6292
6293 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6294 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6295 status_return even if the input is too long to
6296 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6297 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6298 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6299 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6300 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6301 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6302 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6303 int modifiers;
6304 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6305 Lisp_Object c;
6306
6307 #ifdef USE_GTK
6308 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6309 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6310 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6311 (see above). */
6312 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6313 #endif
6314
6315 event.xkey.state
6316 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6317 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6318 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6319
6320 /* This will have to go some day... */
6321
6322 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6323 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6324 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6325 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6326 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6327 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6328 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6329
6330 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6331 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6332 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6333 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6334 not it is combined with Meta. */
6335 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6336 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6337
6338 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6339 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6340 {
6341 Status status_return;
6342
6343 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6344 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6345 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6346 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6347 &status_return);
6348 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6349 {
6350 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6351 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6352 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6353 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6354 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6355 &status_return);
6356 }
6357 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6358 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6359 break;
6360 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6361 {
6362 keysym = NoSymbol;
6363 modifiers = 0;
6364 }
6365 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6366 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6367 abort ();
6368 }
6369 else
6370 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6371 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6372 &compose_status);
6373 #else
6374 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6375 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6376 &compose_status);
6377 #endif
6378
6379 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6380 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6381 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6382 break;
6383
6384 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6385 orig_keysym = keysym;
6386
6387 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6388 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6389 inev.ie.modifiers
6390 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6391 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6392
6393 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6394 translations to characters. */
6395 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6396 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6397 {
6398 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6399 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6400 goto done_keysym;
6401 }
6402
6403 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6404 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6405 {
6406 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6407 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6408 else
6409 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6410 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6411 goto done_keysym;
6412 }
6413
6414 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6415 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6416 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6417 Vx_keysym_table,
6418 Qnil))))
6419 {
6420 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6421 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6422 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6423 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6424 goto done_keysym;
6425 }
6426
6427 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6428 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6429 || keysym == XK_Delete
6430 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6431 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6432 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6433 #endif
6434 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6435 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6436 #ifdef HPUX
6437 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6438 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6439 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6440 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6441 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6442 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6443 #endif
6444 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6445 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6446 #endif
6447 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6448 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6449 #endif
6450 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6451 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6452 #endif
6453 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6454 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6455 #endif
6456 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6457 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6458 #endif
6459 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6460 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6461 #endif
6462 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6463 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6464 #endif
6465 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6466 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6467 #endif
6468 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6469 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6470 #endif
6471 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6472 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6473 #endif
6474 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6475 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6476 #endif
6477 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6478 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6479 #endif
6480 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6481 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6482 #endif
6483 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6484 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6485 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6486 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6487 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6488 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6489 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6490 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6491 don't have real modifiers but
6492 should be treated similarly to
6493 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6494 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6495 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6496 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6497 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6498 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6499 #endif
6500 ))
6501 {
6502 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6503 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6504 key. */
6505 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6506 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6507 goto done_keysym;
6508 }
6509
6510 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6511 register int i;
6512 int nchars, len;
6513
6514 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6515 {
6516 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6517 nchars++;
6518 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6519 }
6520
6521 if (nchars < nbytes)
6522 {
6523 /* Decode the input data. */
6524 int require;
6525
6526 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6527 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6528 we used just above and the locale. */
6529 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6530 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6531 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6532 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6533 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6534 gives us composition information. */
6535 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6536
6537 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6538 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6539 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6540 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6541 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6542 nbytes = coding.produced;
6543 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6544 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6545 }
6546
6547 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6548 character events. */
6549 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6550 {
6551 int ch;
6552 if (nchars == nbytes)
6553 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6554 else
6555 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6556 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6557 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6558 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6559 inev.ie.code = ch;
6560 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6561 }
6562
6563 count += nchars;
6564
6565 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6566
6567 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6568 break;
6569 }
6570 }
6571 done_keysym:
6572 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6573 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6574 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6575 client. */
6576 break;
6577 #else
6578 goto OTHER;
6579 #endif
6580
6581 case KeyRelease:
6582 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6583 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6584 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6585 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6586 client. */
6587 break;
6588 #else
6589 goto OTHER;
6590 #endif
6591
6592 case EnterNotify:
6593 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6594 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6595
6596 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6597
6598 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6599 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6600
6601 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6602 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6603 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6604 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6605 #ifdef USE_GTK
6606 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6607 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6608 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6609 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6610 #endif
6611 goto OTHER;
6612
6613 case FocusIn:
6614 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6615 goto OTHER;
6616
6617 case LeaveNotify:
6618 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6619 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6620
6621 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6622 if (f)
6623 {
6624 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6625 {
6626 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6627 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6628 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6629 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6630 }
6631
6632 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6633 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6634 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6635 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6636 if (any_help_event_p)
6637 do_help = -1;
6638 }
6639 #ifdef USE_GTK
6640 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6641 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6642 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6643 #endif
6644 goto OTHER;
6645
6646 case FocusOut:
6647 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6648 goto OTHER;
6649
6650 case MotionNotify:
6651 {
6652 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6653 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6654 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6655
6656 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6657 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6658 f = last_mouse_frame;
6659 else
6660 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6661
6662 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6663 {
6664 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6665 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6666 }
6667
6668 #ifdef USE_GTK
6669 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6670 f = 0;
6671 #endif
6672 if (f)
6673 {
6674
6675 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6676 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6677 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6678 {
6679 Lisp_Object window;
6680
6681 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6682 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6683 0, 0);
6684
6685 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6686 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6687 will be selected only when it is active. */
6688 if (WINDOWP (window)
6689 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6690 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6691 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6692 create event iff we don't leave the
6693 selected frame. */
6694 && (focus_follows_mouse
6695 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6696 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6697 {
6698 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6699 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6700 }
6701
6702 last_window=window;
6703 }
6704 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6705 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6706 }
6707 else
6708 {
6709 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6710 struct scroll_bar *bar
6711 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6712 event.xmotion.window);
6713
6714 if (bar)
6715 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6716 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6717
6718 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6719 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6720 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6721 }
6722
6723 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6724 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6725 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6726 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6727 do_help = 1;
6728 goto OTHER;
6729 }
6730
6731 case ConfigureNotify:
6732 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6733 #ifdef USE_GTK
6734 if (!f
6735 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6736 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6737 {
6738 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6739 event.xconfigure.height);
6740 f = 0;
6741 }
6742 #endif
6743 if (f)
6744 {
6745 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6746 #ifndef USE_GTK
6747 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6748 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6749
6750 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6751 is called by the code that handles resizing
6752 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6753
6754 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6755 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6756 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6757 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6758 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6759 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6760 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6761 {
6762 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6763 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6764 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6765 }
6766
6767 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6768 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6769 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6770 #endif
6771
6772 #ifdef USE_GTK
6773 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6774 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6775 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6776 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6777 #endif
6778 {
6779 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6780 }
6781
6782 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6783 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6784 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6785 #endif
6786
6787 }
6788 goto OTHER;
6789
6790 case ButtonRelease:
6791 case ButtonPress:
6792 {
6793 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6794 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6795 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6796
6797 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6798 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6799 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6800
6801 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6802 && last_mouse_frame
6803 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6804 f = last_mouse_frame;
6805 else
6806 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6807
6808 #ifdef USE_GTK
6809 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6810 f = 0;
6811 #endif
6812 if (f)
6813 {
6814 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6815 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6816 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6817 {
6818 Lisp_Object window;
6819 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6820 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6821
6822 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6823 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6824
6825 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6826 {
6827 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6828 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6829 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6830 event.xbutton.state));
6831 }
6832 }
6833
6834 if (!tool_bar_p)
6835 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6836 if (! popup_activated ())
6837 #endif
6838 {
6839 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6840 {
6841 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6842 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6843 {
6844 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6845 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6846 }
6847 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6848 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6849 }
6850 else
6851 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6852 }
6853 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6854 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6855 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6856 }
6857 else
6858 {
6859 struct scroll_bar *bar
6860 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6861 event.xbutton.window);
6862
6863 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6864 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6865 scroll bars. */
6866 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6867 {
6868 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6869 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6870 }
6871 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6872 if (bar)
6873 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6874 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6875 }
6876
6877 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6878 {
6879 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6880 last_mouse_frame = f;
6881
6882 if (!tool_bar_p)
6883 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6884 }
6885 else
6886 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6887
6888 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6889 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6890 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6891 if (f != 0)
6892 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6893
6894 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6895 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6896 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6897 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6898 Instead, save it away
6899 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6900 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6901 if (! popup_activated ()
6902 #ifdef USE_GTK
6903 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6904 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6905 #endif
6906 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6907 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6908 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6909 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6910 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6911 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6912 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6913 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6914 {
6915 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6916 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6917 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6918 }
6919 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6920 {
6921 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6922 goto OTHER;
6923 }
6924 else
6925 goto OTHER;
6926 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6927 }
6928 break;
6929
6930 case CirculateNotify:
6931 goto OTHER;
6932
6933 case CirculateRequest:
6934 goto OTHER;
6935
6936 case VisibilityNotify:
6937 goto OTHER;
6938
6939 case MappingNotify:
6940 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6941 local cache. */
6942 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6943 {
6944 case MappingModifier:
6945 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6946 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6947 case MappingKeyboard:
6948 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6949 }
6950 goto OTHER;
6951
6952 case DestroyNotify:
6953 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6954 break;
6955
6956 default:
6957 OTHER:
6958 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6959 BLOCK_INPUT;
6960 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6961 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6962 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6963 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6964 break;
6965 }
6966
6967 done:
6968 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6969 {
6970 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6971 count++;
6972 }
6973
6974 if (do_help
6975 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6976 {
6977 Lisp_Object frame;
6978
6979 if (f)
6980 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6981 else
6982 frame = Qnil;
6983
6984 if (do_help > 0)
6985 {
6986 any_help_event_p = 1;
6987 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6988 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6989 }
6990 else
6991 {
6992 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6993 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6994 }
6995 count++;
6996 }
6997
6998 *eventptr = event;
6999 return count;
7000 }
7001
7002 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7003
7004 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7005 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7006 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7007
7008 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7009 int
7010 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7011 {
7012 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7013 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7014
7015 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7016
7017 if (dpyinfo)
7018 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7019
7020 return finish;
7021 }
7022 #endif
7023
7024
7025 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7026 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7027 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7028
7029 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7030 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7031 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7032 C chars).
7033
7034 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7035
7036 static int
7037 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7038 {
7039 int count = 0;
7040 int event_found = 0;
7041
7042 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7043 {
7044 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7045 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7046 pending_signals = 1;
7047 #endif
7048 return -1;
7049 }
7050
7051 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7052 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7053 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7054 #endif
7055 BLOCK_INPUT;
7056
7057 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7058 input_signal_count++;
7059
7060 ++handling_signal;
7061
7062 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7063 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7064 {
7065 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7066 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7067 }
7068
7069 #ifndef USE_GTK
7070 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7071 {
7072 int finish;
7073 XEvent event;
7074
7075 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7076
7077 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7078 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7079 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7080 continue;
7081 #endif
7082 event_found = 1;
7083
7084 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7085 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7086
7087 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7088 goto out;
7089 }
7090
7091 out:;
7092
7093 #else /* USE_GTK */
7094
7095 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7096 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7097 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7098 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7099
7100 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7101 from all displays. */
7102
7103 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7104 {
7105 current_count = count;
7106 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7107
7108 gtk_main_iteration ();
7109
7110 count = current_count;
7111 current_count = -1;
7112 current_hold_quit = 0;
7113
7114 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7115 break;
7116 }
7117 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7118
7119 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7120 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7121 if (! event_found)
7122 {
7123 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7124 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7125 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7126 x_noop_count++;
7127 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7128 {
7129 x_noop_count=0;
7130
7131 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7132 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7133
7134 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7135
7136 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7137 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7138 }
7139 }
7140
7141 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7142 raise it now. */
7143 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7144 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7145 {
7146 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7147 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7148 }
7149
7150 --handling_signal;
7151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7152
7153 return count;
7154 }
7155
7156
7157
7158 \f
7159 /***********************************************************************
7160 Text Cursor
7161 ***********************************************************************/
7162
7163 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7164 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7165
7166 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7167 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7168 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7169
7170 static void
7171 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7172 {
7173 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7174 XRectangle clip_rect;
7175 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7176
7177 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7178
7179 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7180 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7181 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7182 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7183 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7184
7185 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7186 }
7187
7188
7189 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7190
7191 static void
7192 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7193 {
7194 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7195 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7196 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7197 int x, y, wd, h;
7198 XGCValues xgcv;
7199 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7200 GC gc;
7201
7202 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7203 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7204 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7205 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7206 return;
7207
7208 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7209 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7210 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7211
7212 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7213 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7214 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7215 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7216 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7217 else
7218 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7219 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7220 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7221
7222 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7223 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7224 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7225 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7226 }
7227
7228
7229 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7230
7231 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7232 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7233 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7234 --gerd. */
7235
7236 static void
7237 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7238 {
7239 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7240 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7241
7242 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7243 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7244 and mini-buffer. */
7245 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7246 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7247 return;
7248
7249 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7250 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7251 the bar might not be in the window. */
7252 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7253 {
7254 struct glyph_row *r;
7255 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7256 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7257 }
7258 else
7259 {
7260 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7261 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7262 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7263 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7264 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7265 XGCValues xgcv;
7266
7267 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7268 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7269 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7270 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7271 that the glyph is legible. */
7272 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7273 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7274 else
7275 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7276 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7277
7278 if (gc)
7279 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7280 else
7281 {
7282 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7283 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7284 }
7285
7286 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7287
7288 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7289 {
7290 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7291
7292 if (width < 0)
7293 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7294 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7295
7296 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7297
7298 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7299 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7300 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7301 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7302
7303 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7304 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7305 width, row->height);
7306 }
7307 else
7308 {
7309 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7310
7311 if (width < 0)
7312 width = row->height;
7313
7314 width = min (row->height, width);
7315
7316 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7317 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7318
7319 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7320 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7321 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7322 row->height - width),
7323 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7324 }
7325
7326 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7327 }
7328 }
7329
7330
7331 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7332
7333 static void
7334 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7335 {
7336 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7337 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7338 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7339 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7340 }
7341
7342
7343 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7344
7345 static void
7346 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7347 {
7348 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7349 x, y, width, height, False);
7350 #ifdef USE_GTK
7351 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7352 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7353 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7354 #endif
7355 }
7356
7357
7358 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7359
7360 static void
7361 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7362 {
7363 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7364
7365 if (on_p)
7366 {
7367 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7368 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7369
7370 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7371 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7372 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7373 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7374 {
7375 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7376 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7377 }
7378 else
7379 {
7380 switch (cursor_type)
7381 {
7382 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7383 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7384 break;
7385
7386 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7387 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7388 break;
7389
7390 case BAR_CURSOR:
7391 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7392 break;
7393
7394 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7395 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7396 break;
7397
7398 case NO_CURSOR:
7399 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7400 break;
7401
7402 default:
7403 abort ();
7404 }
7405 }
7406
7407 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7408 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7409 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7410 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7411 #endif
7412 }
7413
7414 #ifndef XFlush
7415 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7416 #endif
7417 }
7418
7419 \f
7420 /* Icons. */
7421
7422 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7423
7424 int
7425 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7426 {
7427 int bitmap_id;
7428
7429 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7430 return 1;
7431
7432 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7433 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7434 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7435 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7436
7437 if (STRINGP (file))
7438 {
7439 #ifdef USE_GTK
7440 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7441 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7442 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7443 return 0;
7444 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7445 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7446 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7447 }
7448 else
7449 {
7450 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7451 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7452 {
7453 int rc = -1;
7454
7455 #ifdef USE_GTK
7456
7457 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7458 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7459 return 0;
7460
7461 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7462
7463 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7464 if (rc != -1)
7465 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7466
7467 #endif
7468
7469 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7470 if (rc == -1)
7471 {
7472 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7473 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7474 if (rc == -1)
7475 return 1;
7476
7477 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7478 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7479 }
7480 }
7481
7482 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7483 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7484 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7485 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7486 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7487
7488 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7489 }
7490
7491 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7492 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7493
7494 return 0;
7495 }
7496
7497
7498 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7499 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7500
7501 int
7502 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7503 {
7504 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7505 return 1;
7506
7507 {
7508 XTextProperty text;
7509 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7510 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7511 text.format = 8;
7512 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7513 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7514 }
7515
7516 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7517 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7518 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7519 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7520
7521 return 0;
7522 }
7523 \f
7524 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7525
7526 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7527 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7528
7529 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7530 be called from a signal handler.
7531 */
7532
7533 struct x_error_message_stack {
7534 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7535 Display *dpy;
7536 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7537 };
7538 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7539
7540 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7541 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7542 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7543
7544 static void
7545 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7546 {
7547 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7548 x_error_message->string,
7549 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7550 }
7551
7552 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7553 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7554 operating on.
7555
7556 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7557 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7558 stored in *x_error_message.
7559
7560 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7561 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7562
7563 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7564
7565 void
7566 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7567 {
7568 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7569
7570 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7571 XSync (dpy, False);
7572
7573 data->dpy = dpy;
7574 data->string[0] = 0;
7575 data->prev = x_error_message;
7576 x_error_message = data;
7577 }
7578
7579 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7580 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7581
7582 void
7583 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7584 {
7585 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7586
7587 BLOCK_INPUT;
7588
7589 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7590 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7591 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7592 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7593
7594 tmp = x_error_message;
7595 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7596 xfree (tmp);
7597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7598 }
7599
7600 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7601 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7602 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7603
7604 void
7605 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7606 {
7607 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7608 XSync (dpy, False);
7609
7610 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7611 {
7612 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7613 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7614 x_uncatch_errors ();
7615 error (format, string);
7616 }
7617 }
7618
7619 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7620 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7621
7622 int
7623 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7624 {
7625 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7626 XSync (dpy, False);
7627
7628 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7629 }
7630
7631 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7632
7633 void
7634 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7635 {
7636 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7637 }
7638
7639 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7640 * idea. --lorentey */
7641 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7642
7643 void
7644 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7645 {
7646 while (x_error_message)
7647 x_uncatch_errors ();
7648 }
7649 #endif
7650
7651 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7652
7653 int
7654 x_catching_errors (void)
7655 {
7656 return x_error_message != 0;
7657 }
7658
7659 #if 0
7660 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7661 x_trace_wire (void)
7662 {
7663 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7664 }
7665 #endif /* ! 0 */
7666
7667 \f
7668 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7669 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7670 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7671 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7672 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7673
7674 static void
7675 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7676 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7677 {
7678 #ifdef USG
7679 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7680 must reestablish each time */
7681 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7682 #endif /* USG */
7683 }
7684
7685 \f
7686 /************************************************************************
7687 Handling X errors
7688 ************************************************************************/
7689
7690 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7691
7692 static char *error_msg;
7693
7694 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7695 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7696
7697 static void
7698 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7699 {
7700 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7701 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7702 int idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7703
7704 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7705 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7706 handling_signal = 0;
7707
7708 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7709 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7710
7711 if (dpyinfo)
7712 {
7713 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7714 frame on it. */
7715 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7716 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7717 }
7718
7719 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7720 that are on the dead display. */
7721 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7722 {
7723 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7724 minibuf_frame
7725 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7726 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7727 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7728 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7729 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7730 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7731 }
7732
7733 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7734 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7735 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7736 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7737 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7738 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7739 {
7740 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7741 trying to find a replacement. */
7742 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7743 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7744 }
7745
7746 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7747 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7748 if (dpyinfo)
7749 {
7750 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7751 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7752 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7753 #ifdef USE_GTK
7754 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7755 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7756 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7757 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7758 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7759 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7760 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7761 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7762 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7763 error_msg);
7764 abort ();
7765 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7766
7767 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7768 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7769
7770 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7771 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7772 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7773 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7774 abort ();
7775
7776 {
7777 Lisp_Object tmp;
7778 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7779 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7780 }
7781 }
7782
7783 if (terminal_list == 0)
7784 {
7785 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7786 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7787 /* NOTREACHED */
7788 }
7789
7790 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7791 #ifdef SIGIO
7792 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7793 #endif
7794 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7795 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7796
7797 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7798 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7799
7800 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7801 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7802
7803 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7804 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7805 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7806 error ("%s", error_msg);
7807 }
7808
7809 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7810 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7811 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7812
7813 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7814 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7815
7816 static int
7817 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7818 {
7819 if (x_error_message)
7820 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7821 else
7822 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7823 return 0;
7824 }
7825
7826 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7827 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7828 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7829
7830 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7831
7832 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7833 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7834
7835 static void NO_INLINE
7836 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7837 {
7838 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7839
7840 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7841 or colors that are not defined. */
7842
7843 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7844 return;
7845
7846 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7847 original error handler. */
7848
7849 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7850 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7851 buf, event->request_code);
7852 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7853 }
7854
7855
7856 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7857 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7858 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7859
7860 static int
7861 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7862 {
7863 char buf[256];
7864
7865 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7866 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7867 return 0;
7868 }
7869 \f
7870 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7871
7872 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7873 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7874 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7875 FONT-OBJECT. */
7876
7877 Lisp_Object
7878 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7879 {
7880 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7881
7882 if (fontset < 0)
7883 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7884 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7885 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7886 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7887 do. */
7888 return font_object;
7889
7890 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7891 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7892 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7893 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7894 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7895
7896 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7897
7898 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7899 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7900 {
7901 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7902 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7903 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7904 }
7905 else
7906 {
7907 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7908 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7909 }
7910
7911 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7912 {
7913 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7914 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7915 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7916 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7917 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7918 }
7919
7920 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7921 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7922 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7923 {
7924 BLOCK_INPUT;
7925 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7926 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7927 }
7928 #endif
7929
7930 return font_object;
7931 }
7932
7933 \f
7934 /***********************************************************************
7935 X Input Methods
7936 ***********************************************************************/
7937
7938 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7939
7940 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7941
7942 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7943 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7944 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7945
7946 static void
7947 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7948 {
7949 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7950 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7951
7952 BLOCK_INPUT;
7953
7954 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7955 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7956 {
7957 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7958 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7959 {
7960 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7961 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7962 }
7963 }
7964
7965 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7966 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7967 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7968 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7969 }
7970
7971 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7972
7973 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7974 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7975 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7976 #endif
7977
7978 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7979 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7980
7981 static void
7982 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7983 {
7984 XIM xim;
7985
7986 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7987 if (use_xim)
7988 {
7989 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7990 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7991 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7992 emacs_class);
7993 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7994
7995 if (xim)
7996 {
7997 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7998 XIMCallback destroy;
7999 #endif
8000
8001 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8002 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8003
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8005 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8006 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8007 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8008 #endif
8009 }
8010 }
8011
8012 else
8013 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8014 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8015 }
8016
8017
8018 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8019
8020 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8021 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8022 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8023 when the callback was registered. */
8024
8025 static void
8026 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8027 {
8028 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8029 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8030
8031 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8032 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8033 return;
8034
8035 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8036
8037 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8038 as they have no XIC. */
8039 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8040 {
8041 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8042
8043 BLOCK_INPUT;
8044 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8045 {
8046 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8047
8048 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8049 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8050 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8051 {
8052 create_frame_xic (f);
8053 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8054 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8055 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8056 {
8057 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8058 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8059 }
8060 }
8061 }
8062
8063 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8064 }
8065 }
8066
8067 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8068
8069
8070 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8071 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8072 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8073 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8074
8075 static void
8076 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8077 {
8078 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8079 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8080 if (use_xim)
8081 {
8082 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8083 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8084 int len;
8085
8086 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8087 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8088 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8089 len = strlen (resource_name);
8090 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8091 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8092 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8093 resource_name, emacs_class,
8094 xim_instantiate_callback,
8095 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8096 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8097 least, hence the configure test. */
8098 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8099 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8100 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8101 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8102 }
8103 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8104 }
8105
8106
8107 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8108
8109 static void
8110 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8111 {
8112 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8113 if (use_xim)
8114 {
8115 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8116 if (dpyinfo->display)
8117 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8118 NULL, emacs_class,
8119 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8120 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8121 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8122 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8123 if (dpyinfo->display)
8124 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8125 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8126 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8127 }
8128 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8129 }
8130
8131 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8132
8133
8134 \f
8135 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8136 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8137
8138 static void
8139 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8140 {
8141 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8142
8143 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8144 is already for the top-left corner. */
8145 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8146 return;
8147
8148 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8149 position that fits on the screen. */
8150 if (flags & XNegative)
8151 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8152 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8153
8154 {
8155 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8156
8157 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8158 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8159 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8160
8161 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8162 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8163 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8164 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8165 is right, though.
8166
8167 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8168 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8169
8170 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8171 #endif
8172
8173 if (flags & YNegative)
8174 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8175 - height + f->top_pos;
8176 }
8177
8178 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8179 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8180 so the flags should correspond. */
8181 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8182 }
8183
8184 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8185 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8186 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8187 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8188 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8189
8190 void
8191 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8192 {
8193 int modified_top, modified_left;
8194
8195 if (change_gravity > 0)
8196 {
8197 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8198 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8199
8200 f->top_pos = yoff;
8201 f->left_pos = xoff;
8202 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8203 if (xoff < 0)
8204 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8205 if (yoff < 0)
8206 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8207 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8208 }
8209 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8210
8211 BLOCK_INPUT;
8212 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8213
8214 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8215 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8216
8217 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8218 {
8219 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8220 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8221 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8222 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8223 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8224 }
8225
8226 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8227 modified_left, modified_top);
8228
8229 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8230 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8231 ? 1 : 0);
8232
8233 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8234 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8235 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8236 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8237 of the frame.
8238
8239 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8240 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8241 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8242
8243 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8244 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8245 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8246 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8247 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8248 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8249
8250 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8251 }
8252
8253 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8254 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8255 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8256 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8257 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8258
8259 static int
8260 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8261 {
8262 Atom actual_type;
8263 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8264 int i, rc, actual_format;
8265 Window wmcheck_window;
8266 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8267 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8268 long max_len = 65536;
8269 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8270 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8271 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8272
8273 BLOCK_INPUT;
8274
8275 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8276 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8277 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8278 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8279 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8280 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8281
8282 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8283 {
8284 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8285 x_uncatch_errors ();
8286 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8287 return 0;
8288 }
8289
8290 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8291 XFree (tmp_data);
8292
8293 /* Check if window exists. */
8294 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8295 x_sync (f);
8296 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8297 {
8298 x_uncatch_errors ();
8299 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8300 return 0;
8301 }
8302
8303 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8304 {
8305 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8306 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8307 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8308 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8309 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8310 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8311
8312 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8313 tmp_data = NULL;
8314 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8315 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8316 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8317 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8318 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8319
8320 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8321 {
8322 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8323 x_uncatch_errors ();
8324 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8325 return 0;
8326 }
8327
8328 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8329 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8330 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8331 }
8332
8333 rc = 0;
8334
8335 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8336 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8337
8338 x_uncatch_errors ();
8339 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8340
8341 return rc;
8342 }
8343
8344 static void
8345 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8346 {
8347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8348
8349 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8350 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8351 make_number (32),
8352 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8353 Fcons
8354 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8355 Fcons
8356 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8357 value != 0
8358 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8359 : Qnil)));
8360 }
8361
8362 void
8363 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8364 {
8365 Lisp_Object frame;
8366 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8367
8368 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8369
8370 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8371 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8372 }
8373
8374 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8375 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8376 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8377
8378 static void
8379 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8380 Window window,
8381 int *size_state,
8382 int *sticky)
8383 {
8384 Atom actual_type;
8385 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8386 int i, rc, actual_format;
8387 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8388 long max_len = 65536;
8389 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8390 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8391 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8392
8393 *sticky = 0;
8394 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8395
8396 BLOCK_INPUT;
8397 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8398 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8399 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8400 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8401 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8402
8403 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8404 {
8405 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8406 x_uncatch_errors ();
8407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8408 return;
8409 }
8410
8411 x_uncatch_errors ();
8412
8413 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8414 {
8415 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8416 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8417 {
8418 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8419 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8420 else
8421 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8422 }
8423 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8424 {
8425 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8426 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8427 else
8428 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8429 }
8430 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8431 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8432 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8433 *sticky = 1;
8434 }
8435
8436 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8437 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8438 }
8439
8440 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8441
8442 static int
8443 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8444 {
8445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8446 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8447 int cur, dummy;
8448
8449 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8450
8451 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8452 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8453 if (!have_net_atom)
8454 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8455
8456 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8457 {
8458 Lisp_Object frame;
8459
8460 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8461
8462 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8463 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8464 are sent at once. */
8465 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8466 {
8467 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8468 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8469 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8470 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8471 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8472 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8473 break;
8474 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8475 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8476 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8477 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8478 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8479 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8480 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8481 break;
8482 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8483 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8484 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8485 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8486 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8487 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8488 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8489 break;
8490 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8491 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8492 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8493 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8494 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8495 break;
8496 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8497 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8498 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8499 else
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8501 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8502 }
8503
8504 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8505
8506 }
8507
8508 return have_net_atom;
8509 }
8510
8511 static void
8512 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8513 {
8514 if (f->async_visible)
8515 {
8516 BLOCK_INPUT;
8517 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8518 x_sync (f);
8519 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8520 }
8521 }
8522
8523
8524 static void
8525 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8526 {
8527 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8528 Lisp_Object lval;
8529 int sticky = 0;
8530
8531 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8532 lval = Qnil;
8533 switch (value)
8534 {
8535 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8536 lval = Qfullwidth;
8537 break;
8538 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8539 lval = Qfullheight;
8540 break;
8541 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8542 lval = Qfullboth;
8543 break;
8544 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8545 lval = Qmaximized;
8546 break;
8547 }
8548
8549 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8550 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8551 }
8552
8553 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8554 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8555 static void
8556 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8557 {
8558 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8559 return;
8560
8561 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8562 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8563
8564 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8565 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8566 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8567
8568 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8569 {
8570 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8571 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8572
8573 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8574 {
8575 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8576 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8577 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8578 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8579 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8580 break;
8581 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8582 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8583 break;
8584 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8585 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8586 }
8587
8588 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8589 width, height);
8590 }
8591 }
8592
8593 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8594 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8595 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8596 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8597 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8598 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8599 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8600
8601 static void
8602 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8603 {
8604 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8605
8606 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8607 window manager window around the frame. */
8608
8609 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8610
8611 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8612 {
8613 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8614
8615 int adjusted_left;
8616 int adjusted_top;
8617
8618 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8619 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8620 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8621
8622 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8623
8624 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8625 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8626
8627 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8628 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8629
8630 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8631 }
8632 else
8633 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8634 frame's position. */
8635
8636 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8637 }
8638
8639
8640 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8641 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8642 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8643 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8644 of an exact comparison. */
8645
8646 static void
8647 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8648 {
8649 int count = 0;
8650
8651 while (count++ < 50)
8652 {
8653 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8654
8655 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8656 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8657 loop. */
8658
8659 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8660 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8661
8662 if (fuzzy)
8663 {
8664 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8665 pixels. */
8666
8667 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8668 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8669 return;
8670 }
8671 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8672 return;
8673 }
8674
8675 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8676 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8677
8678 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8679 }
8680
8681
8682 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8683 void
8684 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8685 {
8686 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8687
8688 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8689 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8690 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8691
8692 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8693 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8694
8695 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8696 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8697 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8698 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8699 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8700
8701 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8702 {
8703 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8704 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8705 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8706 BLOCK_INPUT;
8707 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8708
8709 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8710 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8711
8712 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8713 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8714
8715 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8716 break; /* Timeout */
8717 }
8718 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8719 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8720 }
8721
8722
8723 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8724 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8725 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8726 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8727
8728 static void
8729 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8730 {
8731 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8732
8733 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8734 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8735 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8736 ? 0
8737 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8738
8739 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8740
8741 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8742 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8743 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8744 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8745
8746 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8747 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8748 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8749 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8750
8751
8752 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8753 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8754 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8755 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8756 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8757
8758 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8759 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8760 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8761 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8762
8763 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8764 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8765 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8766 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8767 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8768
8769 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8770 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8771
8772 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8773 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8774 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8775 if (f->async_visible)
8776 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8777 else
8778 {
8779 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8780 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8781 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8782 x_sync (f);
8783 }
8784 }
8785
8786
8787 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8788 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8789 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8790 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8791
8792 void
8793 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8794 {
8795 BLOCK_INPUT;
8796
8797 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8798 {
8799 int r, c;
8800
8801 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8802 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8803 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8804 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8805 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8806 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8807 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8808 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8809 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8810 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8811 is however. */
8812 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8813 #endif
8814 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8815 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8816 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8817 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8818 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8819 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8820 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8821 }
8822
8823 #ifdef USE_GTK
8824 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8825 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8826 else
8827 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8828 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8829
8830 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8831
8832 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8833
8834 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8835 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8836
8837 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8838 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8839 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8840 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8841 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8842
8843 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8844 }
8845 \f
8846 /* Mouse warping. */
8847
8848 void
8849 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8850 {
8851 int pix_x, pix_y;
8852
8853 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8854 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8855
8856 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8857 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8858
8859 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8860 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8861
8862 BLOCK_INPUT;
8863
8864 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8865 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8866 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8867 }
8868
8869 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8870
8871 void
8872 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8873 {
8874 BLOCK_INPUT;
8875
8876 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8877 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8878 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8879 }
8880 \f
8881 /* Raise frame F. */
8882
8883 void
8884 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8885 {
8886 BLOCK_INPUT;
8887 if (f->async_visible)
8888 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8889
8890 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8891 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8892 }
8893
8894 /* Lower frame F. */
8895
8896 static void
8897 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8898 {
8899 if (f->async_visible)
8900 {
8901 BLOCK_INPUT;
8902 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8903 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8904 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8905 }
8906 }
8907
8908 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8909
8910 void
8911 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8912 {
8913 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8914 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8915
8916 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8917 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8918 {
8919 Lisp_Object frame;
8920 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8921 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8922 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8923 make_number (32),
8924 Fcons (make_number (1),
8925 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8926 Qnil)));
8927 }
8928 }
8929
8930 static void
8931 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8932 {
8933 if (raise_flag)
8934 x_raise_frame (f);
8935 else
8936 x_lower_frame (f);
8937 }
8938 \f
8939 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8940
8941 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8942
8943 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8944
8945 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8946
8947 static void
8948 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8949 {
8950 unsigned long data[2];
8951 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8952
8953 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8954 data[1] = flags;
8955
8956 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8957 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8958 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8959 }
8960 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8961
8962 static void
8963 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8964 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8965 {
8966 XEvent event;
8967
8968 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8969 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8970 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8971 event.xclient.format = 32;
8972 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
8973 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
8974 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8975 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8976 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8977
8978 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8979 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8980 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8981 }
8982 \f
8983 /* Change of visibility. */
8984
8985 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8986 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8987 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8988 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8989 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8990 finishes with it. */
8991
8992 void
8993 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
8994 {
8995 Lisp_Object type;
8996 int original_top, original_left;
8997 int retry_count = 2;
8998
8999 retry:
9000
9001 BLOCK_INPUT;
9002
9003 type = x_icon_type (f);
9004 if (!NILP (type))
9005 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9006
9007 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9008 {
9009 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9010 call x_set_offset a second time
9011 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9012 before the window gets really visible. */
9013 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9014 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9015 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9016 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9017
9018 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9019
9020 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9021 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9022 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9023 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9024 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9025 else
9026 {
9027 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9028 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9029 }
9030 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9031 #ifdef USE_GTK
9032 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9033 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9034 #else
9035 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9036 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9037 else
9038 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9039 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9040 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9041 }
9042
9043 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9044
9045 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9046 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9047 so that incoming events are handled. */
9048 {
9049 Lisp_Object frame;
9050 int count;
9051 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9052 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9053 will set it when they are handled. */
9054 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9055
9056 original_left = f->left_pos;
9057 original_top = f->top_pos;
9058
9059 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9061
9062 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9063
9064 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9065 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9066 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9067 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9068
9069 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9070 because the window manager may choose the position
9071 and we don't want to override it. */
9072
9073 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9074 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9075 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9076 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9077 && previously_visible)
9078 {
9079 Drawable rootw;
9080 int x, y;
9081 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9082
9083 BLOCK_INPUT;
9084
9085 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9086 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9087 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9088 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9089 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9090 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9091 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9092 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9093 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9094
9095 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9096 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9097 original_left, original_top);
9098
9099 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9100 }
9101
9102 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9103
9104 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9105 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9106 MapNotify at all.. */
9107 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9108 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9109 {
9110 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9111 x_sync (f);
9112
9113 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9114 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9115 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9116 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9117 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9118 probably a bug. */
9119 if (input_polling_used ())
9120 {
9121 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9122 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9123 handler reset it. */
9124 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9125 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9126 poll_for_input_1 ();
9127 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9128 }
9129
9130 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9131 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9132 }
9133
9134 /* 2000-09-28: In
9135
9136 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9137 (iconify-frame f)
9138 (raise-frame f))
9139
9140 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9141 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9142 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9143 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9144
9145 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9146 goto retry;
9147 }
9148 }
9149
9150 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9151
9152 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9153
9154 void
9155 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9156 {
9157 Window window;
9158
9159 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9160 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9161
9162 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9163 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9164 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9165
9166 BLOCK_INPUT;
9167
9168 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9169 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9170 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9171 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9172 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9173 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9174
9175 #ifdef USE_GTK
9176 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9177 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9178 else
9179 #else
9180 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9181 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9182 else
9183 #endif
9184 {
9185
9186 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9187 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9188 {
9189 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9190 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9191 }
9192 }
9193
9194 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9195 just by the event that we get from the server.
9196 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9197 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9198 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9199 f->visible = 0;
9200 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9201 f->async_visible = 0;
9202 f->async_iconified = 0;
9203
9204 x_sync (f);
9205
9206 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9207 }
9208
9209 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9210
9211 void
9212 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9213 {
9214 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9215 int result;
9216 #endif
9217 Lisp_Object type;
9218
9219 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9220 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9221 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9222
9223 if (f->async_iconified)
9224 return;
9225
9226 BLOCK_INPUT;
9227
9228 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9229
9230 type = x_icon_type (f);
9231 if (!NILP (type))
9232 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9233
9234 #ifdef USE_GTK
9235 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9236 {
9237 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9238 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9239
9240 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9241 f->iconified = 1;
9242 f->visible = 1;
9243 f->async_iconified = 1;
9244 f->async_visible = 0;
9245 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9246 return;
9247 }
9248 #endif
9249
9250 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9251
9252 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9253 {
9254 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9255 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9256 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9257 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9258 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9259 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9260 so we have to record it here. */
9261 f->iconified = 1;
9262 f->visible = 1;
9263 f->async_iconified = 1;
9264 f->async_visible = 0;
9265 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9266 return;
9267 }
9268
9269 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9270 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9271 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9272 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9273
9274 if (!result)
9275 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9276
9277 f->async_iconified = 1;
9278 f->async_visible = 0;
9279
9280
9281 BLOCK_INPUT;
9282 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9283 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9284 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9285
9286 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9287 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9288 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9289 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9290 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9291 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9292
9293 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9294 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9295
9296 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9297 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9298 {
9299 XEvent msg;
9300
9301 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9302 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9303 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9304 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9305 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9306
9307 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9308 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9309 False,
9310 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9311 &msg))
9312 {
9313 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9314 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9315 }
9316 }
9317
9318 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9319 IconicState. */
9320 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9321
9322 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9323 {
9324 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9325 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9326 }
9327
9328 f->async_iconified = 1;
9329 f->async_visible = 0;
9330
9331 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9332 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9333 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9334 }
9335
9336 \f
9337 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9338
9339 void
9340 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9341 {
9342 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9343 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9344 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9345 Lisp_Object bar;
9346 struct scroll_bar *b;
9347 #endif
9348
9349 BLOCK_INPUT;
9350
9351 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9352 commands to the X server. */
9353 if (dpyinfo->display)
9354 {
9355 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9356 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9357 face. */
9358 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9359 free_frame_faces (f);
9360
9361 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9362 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9363
9364 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9365 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9366 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9367 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9368 toolkit scroll bars. */
9369 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9370 {
9371 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9372 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9373 }
9374 #endif
9375
9376 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9377 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9378 free_frame_xic (f);
9379 #endif
9380
9381 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9382 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9383 {
9384 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9385 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9386 }
9387 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9388 we are using a toolkit. */
9389 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9390 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9391
9392 free_frame_menubar (f);
9393 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9394
9395 #ifdef USE_GTK
9396 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9397 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9398
9399 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9400 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9401 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9402
9403 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9404 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9405 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9406 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9407 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9408 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9409
9410 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9411 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9412 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9413 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9414 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9415 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9416 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9417 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9418 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9419 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9420 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9421 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9422 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9423 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9424 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9425
9426 x_free_gcs (f);
9427 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9428 }
9429
9430 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9431 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9432 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9433
9434 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9435 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9436 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9437 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9438 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9439 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9440
9441 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9442 {
9443 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9444 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9445 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9446 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9447 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9448 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9449 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9450 }
9451
9452 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9453 }
9454
9455
9456 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9457
9458 static void
9459 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9460 {
9461 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9462
9463 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9464 commands to the X server. */
9465 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9466 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9467
9468 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9469 }
9470
9471 \f
9472 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9473
9474 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9475 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9476 that the window now has.
9477 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9478 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9479 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9480
9481 #ifndef USE_GTK
9482 void
9483 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9484 {
9485 XSizeHints size_hints;
9486 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9487
9488 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9489 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9490
9491 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9492 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9493
9494 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9495 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9496
9497 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9498 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9499 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9500 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9501 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9502 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9503
9504 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9505 {
9506 int base_width, base_height;
9507 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9508
9509 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9510 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9511
9512 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9513
9514 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9515 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9516 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9517 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9518 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9519
9520 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9521 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9522 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9523
9524 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9525 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9526 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9527 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9528 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9529 }
9530
9531 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9532 if (flags)
9533 {
9534 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9535 goto no_read;
9536 }
9537
9538 {
9539 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9540 long supplied_return;
9541 int value;
9542
9543 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9544 &supplied_return);
9545
9546 if (flags)
9547 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9548 else
9549 {
9550 if (value == 0)
9551 hints.flags = 0;
9552 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9553 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9554 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9555 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9556 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9557 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9558 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9559 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9560 }
9561 }
9562
9563 no_read:
9564
9565 #ifdef PWinGravity
9566 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9567 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9568
9569 if (user_position)
9570 {
9571 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9572 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9573 }
9574 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9575
9576 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9577 }
9578 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9579
9580 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9581
9582 static void
9583 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9584 {
9585 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9586 Arg al[1];
9587
9588 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9589 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9590 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9591 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9592
9593 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9594 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9595
9596 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9597 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9598 }
9599
9600 static void
9601 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9602 {
9603 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9604
9605 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9606 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9607 #endif
9608
9609 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9610 {
9611 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9612 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9613 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9614 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9615 }
9616 else
9617 {
9618 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9619 pixmap. */
9620 return;
9621 }
9622
9623
9624 #ifdef USE_GTK
9625 {
9626 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9627 return;
9628 }
9629
9630 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9631
9632 {
9633 Arg al[1];
9634 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9635 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9636 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9637 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9638 }
9639
9640 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9641
9642 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9643 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9644
9645 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9646 }
9647
9648 void
9649 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9650 {
9651 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9652
9653 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9654 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9655 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9656
9657 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9658 }
9659
9660 \f
9661 /***********************************************************************
9662 Fonts
9663 ***********************************************************************/
9664
9665 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9666
9667 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9668 font table. */
9669
9670 static void
9671 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9672 {
9673 Lisp_Object frame;
9674
9675 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9676 if (font->driver->check)
9677 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9678 }
9679
9680 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9681
9682 \f
9683 /***********************************************************************
9684 Initialization
9685 ***********************************************************************/
9686
9687 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9688 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9689 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9690 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9691
9692 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9693 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9694 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9695
9696 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9697 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9698 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9699 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9700 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9701 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9702 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9703 };
9704
9705 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9706
9707 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9708
9709 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9710
9711 static int x_initialized;
9712
9713 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9714 the screen number from the server number. */
9715 static int
9716 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9717 {
9718 int seen_colon = 0;
9719 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9720 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9721 int length_until_period = 0;
9722
9723 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9724 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9725 length_until_period++;
9726
9727 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9728 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9729 name1 += 4;
9730 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9731 name2 += 4;
9732 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9733 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9734 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9735 name1 += system_name_length;
9736 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9737 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9738 name2 += system_name_length;
9739 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9740 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9741 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9742 name1 += length_until_period;
9743 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9744 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9745 name2 += length_until_period;
9746
9747 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9748 {
9749 if (*name1 == ':')
9750 seen_colon = 1;
9751 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9752 return 1;
9753 }
9754 return (seen_colon
9755 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9756 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9757 }
9758
9759 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9760 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9761 to 5. */
9762 static void
9763 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9764 {
9765 int nr = 0;
9766 int off = 0;
9767
9768 while (!(mask & 1))
9769 {
9770 off++;
9771 mask >>= 1;
9772 }
9773
9774 while (mask & 1)
9775 {
9776 nr++;
9777 mask >>= 1;
9778 }
9779
9780 *offset = off;
9781 *bits = nr;
9782 }
9783
9784 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9785 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9786
9787 int
9788 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9789 {
9790 int dpy_ok = 1;
9791 Display *dpy;
9792
9793 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9794 if (dpy)
9795 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9796 else
9797 dpy_ok = 0;
9798 return dpy_ok;
9799 }
9800
9801 #ifdef USE_GTK
9802 static void
9803 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9804 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9805 {
9806 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9807 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9808 }
9809 #endif
9810
9811 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9812 the structure that describes the open display.
9813 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9814
9815 struct x_display_info *
9816 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9817 {
9818 int connection;
9819 Display *dpy;
9820 struct terminal *terminal;
9821 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9822 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9823 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9824
9825 BLOCK_INPUT;
9826
9827 if (!x_initialized)
9828 {
9829 x_initialize ();
9830 ++x_initialized;
9831 }
9832
9833 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9834 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9835
9836 #ifdef USE_GTK
9837 {
9838 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9839 int argc;
9840 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9841 char **argv2 = argv;
9842 guint id;
9843
9844 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9845 {
9846 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9847 }
9848 else
9849 {
9850 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9851 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9852
9853 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9854 argv[argc] = 0;
9855
9856 argc = 0;
9857 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9858
9859 if (! NILP (display_name))
9860 {
9861 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9862 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9863 }
9864
9865 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9866 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9867
9868 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9869
9870 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9871 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9872 {
9873 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9874 putenv (fix_events);
9875 }
9876
9877 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9878 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9879 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9880 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9881 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9882 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9883
9884 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9885 fixup_locale ();
9886 xg_initialize ();
9887
9888 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9889
9890 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9891 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9892
9893 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9894 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9895 {
9896 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9897 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9898
9899 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9900 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9901
9902 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9903 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9904 }
9905 #endif
9906
9907 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9908 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9909 }
9910 }
9911 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9912 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9913 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9914 errors with X11R5:
9915 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9916 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9917 So let's not use it until R6. */
9918 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9919 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9920 #endif
9921
9922 {
9923 int argc = 0;
9924 char *argv[3];
9925
9926 argv[0] = "";
9927 argc = 1;
9928 if (xrm_option)
9929 {
9930 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9931 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9932 }
9933 turn_on_atimers (0);
9934 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9935 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9936 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9937 &argc, argv);
9938 turn_on_atimers (1);
9939
9940 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9941 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9942 fixup_locale ();
9943 #endif
9944 }
9945
9946 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9947 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9948 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9949 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9950 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9951
9952 /* Detect failure. */
9953 if (dpy == 0)
9954 {
9955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9956 return 0;
9957 }
9958
9959 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9960
9961 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9962 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9963 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9964
9965 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9966
9967 {
9968 struct x_display_info *share;
9969 Lisp_Object tail;
9970
9971 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9972 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9973 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9974 SSDATA (display_name)))
9975 break;
9976 if (share)
9977 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9978 else
9979 {
9980 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9981 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9982 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
9983
9984 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9985 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9986 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9987 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
9988 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
9989
9990 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
9991 {
9992 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
9993
9994 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9995 list of terminals. */
9996 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9997 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
9998 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
9999 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10000
10001 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10002 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10003 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10004 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10005 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10006 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10007 BLOCK_INPUT;
10008 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10009 terminal_list = terminal;
10010 UNGCPRO;
10011 }
10012
10013 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10014 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10015 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10016 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10017 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10018 }
10019 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10020 }
10021
10022 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10023 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10024 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10025
10026 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10027 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10028 x_display_name_list);
10029 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10030
10031 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10032
10033 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10034 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10035 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10036 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10037
10038 #if 0
10039 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10040 #endif /* ! 0 */
10041
10042 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10043 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10044 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10045 + 2);
10046 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10047 SSDATA (Vinvocation_name), SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10048
10049 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10050 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10051
10052 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10053 #ifdef USE_GTK
10054 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10055 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10056 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10057
10058 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10059 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10060
10061 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10062 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10063 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10064 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10065 #else
10066 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10067 #endif
10068 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10069 all versions. */
10070 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10071
10072 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10073 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10074 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10075 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10076 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10077 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10078 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10079 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10080 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10081 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10082 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10083 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10084 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10085 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10086 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10087 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10088 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10089 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10090 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10091 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10092 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10093 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10094 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10095 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10096 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10097 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10098 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10099 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10100
10101 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10102 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10103 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10104
10105 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10106 {
10107 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10108 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10109 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10110 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10111 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10112 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10113 }
10114
10115 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10116 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10117 {
10118 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10119 {
10120 Lisp_Object value;
10121 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10122 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10123 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10124 Qnil, Qnil);
10125 if (STRINGP (value)
10126 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10127 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10128 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10129 }
10130 }
10131 else
10132 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10133 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10134
10135 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10136 {
10137 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10138 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10139 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10140 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10141 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10142 for example). */
10143 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10144 double d;
10145 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10146 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10147 }
10148 #endif
10149
10150 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10151 {
10152 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10153 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10154 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10155 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10156 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10157 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10158 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10159 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10160 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10161 }
10162
10163 {
10164 const struct
10165 {
10166 const char *name;
10167 Atom *atom;
10168 } atom_refs[] = {
10169 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10170 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10171 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10172 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10173 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10174 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10175 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10176 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10177 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10178 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10179 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10180 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10181 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10182 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10183 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10184 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10185 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10186 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10187 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10188 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10189 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10190 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10191 /* For properties of font. */
10192 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10193 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10194 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10195 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10196 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10197 /* Ghostscript support. */
10198 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10199 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10200 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10201 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10202 /* EWMH */
10203 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10204 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10205 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10206 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10207 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10208 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10209 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10210 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10211 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10212 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10213 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10214 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10215 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10216 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10217 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10218 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10219 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10220 /* Session management */
10221 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10222 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10223 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10224 };
10225
10226 int i;
10227 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10228 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10229 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10230 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10231 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10232 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10233
10234 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10235 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10236
10237 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10238 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10239 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10240 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10241
10242 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10243 False, atoms_return);
10244
10245 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10246 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10247
10248 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10249 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10250
10251 xfree (atom_names);
10252 xfree (atoms_return);
10253 }
10254
10255 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10256 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10257 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10258 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10259
10260 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10261 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10262 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10263
10264 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10265 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10266
10267 {
10268 dpyinfo->gray
10269 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10270 gray_bitmap_bits,
10271 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10272 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10273 }
10274
10275 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10276 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10277 #endif
10278
10279 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10280
10281 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10282 if (connection != 0)
10283 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10284
10285 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10286 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10287 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10288
10289 #ifdef SIGIO
10290 if (interrupt_input)
10291 init_sigio (connection);
10292 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10293
10294 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10295 {
10296 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10297 Font font;
10298
10299 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10300 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10301 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10302 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10303 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10304 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10305 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10306 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10307 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10308 abort ();
10309 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10310 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10311 x_uncatch_errors ();
10312 }
10313 #endif
10314
10315 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10316 for debugging X code. */
10317 {
10318 Lisp_Object value;
10319 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10320 build_string ("synchronous"),
10321 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10322 Qnil, Qnil);
10323 if (STRINGP (value)
10324 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10325 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10326 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10327 }
10328
10329 {
10330 Lisp_Object value;
10331 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10332 build_string ("useXIM"),
10333 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10334 Qnil, Qnil);
10335 #ifdef USE_XIM
10336 if (STRINGP (value)
10337 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10338 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10339 use_xim = 0;
10340 #else
10341 if (STRINGP (value)
10342 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10343 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10344 use_xim = 1;
10345 #endif
10346 }
10347
10348 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10349 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10350 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10351 tty. */
10352 if (terminal->id == 1)
10353 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10354 #endif
10355
10356 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10357
10358 return dpyinfo;
10359 }
10360 \f
10361 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10362 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10363
10364 static void
10365 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10366 {
10367 struct terminal *t;
10368
10369 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10370 X display. */
10371 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10372 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10373 {
10374 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10375 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10376 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10377 x_session_close ();
10378 #endif
10379 delete_terminal (t);
10380 break;
10381 }
10382
10383 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10384
10385 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10386 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10387 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10388 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10389 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10390 else
10391 {
10392 Lisp_Object tail;
10393
10394 tail = x_display_name_list;
10395 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10396 {
10397 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10398 {
10399 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10400 break;
10401 }
10402 tail = XCDR (tail);
10403 }
10404 }
10405
10406 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10407 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10408
10409 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10410 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10411 else
10412 {
10413 struct x_display_info *tail;
10414
10415 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10416 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10417 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10418 }
10419
10420 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10421 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10422 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10423 xfree (dpyinfo);
10424 }
10425
10426 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10427
10428 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10429 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10430 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10431 that slows us down. */
10432
10433 static void
10434 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10435 {
10436 BLOCK_INPUT;
10437 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10438 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10439 {
10440 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10441 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10442 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10443 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10444 }
10445 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10446 }
10447
10448 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10449 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10450 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10451 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10452 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10453 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10454 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10455
10456 void
10457 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10458 {
10459 BLOCK_INPUT;
10460 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10461 {
10462 EMACS_TIME interval;
10463
10464 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10465 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10466 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10467 }
10468 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10469 }
10470
10471 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10472
10473 \f
10474 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10475
10476 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10477
10478 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10479 {
10480 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10481 x_produce_glyphs,
10482 x_write_glyphs,
10483 x_insert_glyphs,
10484 x_clear_end_of_line,
10485 x_scroll_run,
10486 x_after_update_window_line,
10487 x_update_window_begin,
10488 x_update_window_end,
10489 x_cursor_to,
10490 x_flush,
10491 #ifdef XFlush
10492 x_flush,
10493 #else
10494 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10495 #endif
10496 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10497 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10498 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10499 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10500 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10501 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10502 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10503 x_draw_glyph_string,
10504 x_define_frame_cursor,
10505 x_clear_frame_area,
10506 x_draw_window_cursor,
10507 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10508 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10509 };
10510
10511
10512 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10513 void
10514 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10515 {
10516 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10517
10518 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10519 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10520 if (!terminal->name)
10521 return;
10522
10523 BLOCK_INPUT;
10524 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10525 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10526 X display. */
10527 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10528 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10529 #endif
10530
10531 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10532 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10533 if (dpyinfo->display)
10534 {
10535 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10536 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10537
10538 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10539 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10540 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10541 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10542
10543 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10544 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10545 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10546 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10547 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10548 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10549 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10550 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10551 leaks in other situations. */
10552 #if 0
10553 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10554 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10555 #else
10556 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10557 #endif
10558 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10559 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10560 closing all the displays. */
10561 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10562 #endif
10563
10564 #ifdef USE_GTK
10565 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10566 #else
10567 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10568 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10569 #else
10570 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10571 #endif
10572 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10573 }
10574
10575 /* Mark as dead. */
10576 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10577 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10578 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10579 }
10580
10581 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10582 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10583
10584 static struct terminal *
10585 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10586 {
10587 struct terminal *terminal;
10588
10589 terminal = create_terminal ();
10590
10591 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10592 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10593 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10594
10595 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10596
10597 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10598 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10599 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10600 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10601 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10602 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10603 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10604 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10605 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10606 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10607 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10608 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10609 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10610 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10611 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10612 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10613 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10614 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10615 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10616 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10617
10618 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10619 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10620
10621 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10622 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10623 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10624 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10625 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10626 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10627 off the bottom. */
10628
10629 return terminal;
10630 }
10631
10632 void
10633 x_initialize (void)
10634 {
10635 baud_rate = 19200;
10636
10637 x_noop_count = 0;
10638 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10639 any_help_event_p = 0;
10640 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10641
10642 #ifdef USE_GTK
10643 current_count = -1;
10644 #endif
10645
10646 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10647 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10648
10649 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10650 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10651
10652 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10653
10654 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10655 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10656 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10657 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10658 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10659 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10660 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10661
10662 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10663 #endif
10664
10665 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10666 #ifndef USE_GTK
10667 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10668 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10669 #endif
10670 #endif
10671
10672 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10673 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10674 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10675
10676 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10677 original error handler. */
10678 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10679 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10680
10681 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10682
10683 xgselect_initialize ();
10684 }
10685
10686
10687 void
10688 syms_of_xterm (void)
10689 {
10690 x_error_message = NULL;
10691
10692 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10693 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10694
10695 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10696 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10697
10698 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10699 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10700
10701 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10702 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10703
10704 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10705 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10706
10707 #ifdef USE_GTK
10708 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10709 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10710
10711 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10712 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10713 #endif
10714
10715 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10716 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10717 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10718 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10719 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10720 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10721 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10722 sizes. */);
10723 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10724
10725 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10726 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10727 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10728 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10729 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10730 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10731 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10732
10733 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10734 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10735 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10736 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10737 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10738 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10739 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10740 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10741 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10742
10743 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10744 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10745 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10746 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10747 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10748 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10749 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10750 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10751 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10752 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10753 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10754 #elif USE_GTK
10755 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10756 #else
10757 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10758 #endif
10759 #else
10760 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10761 #endif
10762
10763 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10764 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10765
10766 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10767 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10768 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10769 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10770 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10771 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10772 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10773 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10774 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10775
10776 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10777 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10778 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10779 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10780 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10781 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10782
10783 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10784 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10785 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10786 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10787 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10788 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10789
10790 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10791 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10792 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10793 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10794 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10795 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10796
10797 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10798 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10799 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10800 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10801 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10802 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10803
10804 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10805 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10806 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10807 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10808 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10809 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10810 }
10811
10812 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */